blob: 83cacbab71742f043960342b3b4505a957c7bd3e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Duncan Sandsb84abcd2007-09-11 14:35:41 +000042#include "llvm/ParameterAttributes.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000048#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000050#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000052#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000053#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000059#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000060#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000061using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000062using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000063
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000064STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
65STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
68STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000071 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
72 : public FunctionPass,
73 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000074 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000075 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
76 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000077 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000078 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000079 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000080 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000081 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
82
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000083 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
84 /// isn't already in it.
85 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
86 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
87 Worklist.push_back(I);
88 }
89
90 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
91 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
92 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
93 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
94
95 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
96 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
97
98 WorklistMap.erase(It);
99 }
100
101 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
102 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
103 Worklist.pop_back();
104 WorklistMap.erase(I);
105 return I;
106 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000107
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000108
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000109 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
110 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
111 /// now.
112 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000113 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000114 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000116 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 }
118
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000119 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
120 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
121 ///
122 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
123 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
124 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000125 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000126 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000127
128 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
129 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
130 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
131 ///
132 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
133 ///
134 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
135 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
136
137 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
138 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000139 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000140 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
141 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
142 }
143
144 return R;
145 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000146
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000148 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000149
150 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000151
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000153 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000154 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000155 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000156 }
157
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000158 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
159
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000160 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
161 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
162 // Return Value:
163 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000164 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000165 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000166 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000167 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000170 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000175 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000180 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000183 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000190 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
191 Instruction *LHS,
192 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000193 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
194 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000195
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000196 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
197 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000198 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000199 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000200 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000202 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000203 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
205 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000206 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
213 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000214 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000215 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
216 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000217 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000218 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
219 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000220 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
221 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000222 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000223 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000224 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000225 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000226 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000227 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000228 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000229 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000230 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000231
232 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000233 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000234
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000235 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000236 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000237 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000238 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000239
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000240 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
242 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
243 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000244 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000245 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
246 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000247 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
248 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000249 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000250 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 }
252
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000253 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
254 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
255 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000256 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
257 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000258 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000259
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000260 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000261 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000262
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000263 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000264 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000265 return C;
266 }
267
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000268 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
269 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
270 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
271 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
272 // modified.
273 //
274 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000275 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000276 if (&I != V) {
277 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
278 return &I;
279 } else {
280 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
281 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000282 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000283 return &I;
284 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000286
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000287 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
288 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
289 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
290 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
291 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
292 //
293 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
294 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
295 if (Old != New)
296 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
297 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000298 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000299 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000300 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 return true;
302 }
303
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000304 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
305 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
306 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
307 // this function.
308 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
309 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
310 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000311 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000312 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000313 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
314 }
315
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000316 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000317 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
318 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
319 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
320 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000321 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
322 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000323 Instruction *InsertBefore);
324
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000325 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
326 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000327 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000328
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000329 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
330 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
331 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
332
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000333 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
334 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000335 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
336 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
337 unsigned Depth = 0);
338
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000339 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
340 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
341
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000342 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
343 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
344 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
345 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
346
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000347 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
348 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
349 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
350 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000351 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
352
353
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000354 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
355 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000356
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000357 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000358 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000359 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000360 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000361 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000362 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000363 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000364
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000365 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000366 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000367
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000368 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000369 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000370}
371
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000373// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000374static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
375 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
376 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000377 return 3;
378 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000379 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000380 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
381 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000382}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000383
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000384// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
385// it.
386static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000387 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000388}
389
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000390// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
391// though a va_arg area...
392static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000393 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
394 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
395 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000396 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000397 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000398}
399
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000400/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
401/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
402static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
403 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000404 return I->getOperand(0);
405 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000406 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000407 return CE->getOperand(0);
408 return 0;
409}
410
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000411/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
412/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000413static Instruction::CastOps
414isEliminableCastPair(
415 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
416 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
417 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
418 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
419) {
420
421 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
422 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000423
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000424 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
425 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
426 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000427
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000428 return Instruction::CastOps(
429 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
430 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000431}
432
433/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
434/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
435/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000436static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
437 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000438 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
439
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000440 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000442 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000443 return false;
444 return true;
445}
446
447/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
448/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
449/// casts that are known to not do anything...
450///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000451Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
452 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000453 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
454 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
455 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000456 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000457
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000458 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000461// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
462// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000463//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000464// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
465// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
466// binary operators.
467//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000468// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
469// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000470//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000471bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000472 bool Changed = false;
473 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
474 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000475
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000476 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
477 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000478 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
479 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
480 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000481 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
482 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
483 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000484 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
485 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
486 return true;
487 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
488 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
489 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
490 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
491 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
492
493 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000494 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000495 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
496 Op1->getOperand(0),
497 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000498 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000499 I.setOperand(0, New);
500 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
501 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000502 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000503 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000504 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000505}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000506
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000507/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
508/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
509/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
510bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 return false;
513 I.swapOperands();
514 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
515 return true;
516}
517
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000518// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
519// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000520//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000521static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
522 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000523 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000524
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000525 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
526 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
527 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000528 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000529}
530
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000531static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
532 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000533 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000534
535 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000536 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000537 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000538 return 0;
539}
540
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000541// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
542// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000543// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
544// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000545//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000547 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000548 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000550 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000551 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000552 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000553 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000554 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000555 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000556 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000557 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000558 return I->getOperand(0);
559 }
560 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000561 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000562}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000563
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000564/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
565/// expression, return it.
566static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
567 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
568 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
569 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
570 return cast<User>(V);
571 return false;
572}
573
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000574/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000575static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000576 APInt Val(C->getValue());
577 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000578}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000579/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000580static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000581 APInt Val(C->getValue());
582 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000583}
584/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
585static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
586 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
587}
588/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
589static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
590 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
591}
592/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
593static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
594 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
595}
596/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
597static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
598 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000599}
600
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000601/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
602/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000603/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
604/// processing.
605/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
606/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
607/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
608/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
609/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
610/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000611static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000612 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000613 assert(V && "No Value?");
614 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000615 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000616 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000617 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000619 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000620 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
621 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000622 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000623 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
624 return;
625 }
626
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000627 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
628 return; // Limit search depth.
629
630 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
631 if (!I) return;
632
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000633 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000634 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000635
636 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000637 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000638 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000640 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
641 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000642 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
643 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
644
645 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
646 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
647 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
648 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
649 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000650 }
651 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000653 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
654 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000655 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
657
658 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
659 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
660 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
661 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
662 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000663 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000664 case Instruction::Xor: {
665 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
666 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
667 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
668 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
669
670 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
671 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
672 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
673 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
674 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
675 return;
676 }
677 case Instruction::Select:
678 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
679 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
680 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
681 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
682
683 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
684 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
685 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
686 return;
687 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
688 case Instruction::FPExt:
689 case Instruction::FPToUI:
690 case Instruction::FPToSI:
691 case Instruction::SIToFP:
692 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
693 case Instruction::UIToFP:
694 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
695 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000697 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000698 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
699 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000700 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
701 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
703 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
704 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000705 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
706 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000707 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000708 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000709 case Instruction::BitCast: {
710 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
711 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
712 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
713 return;
714 }
715 break;
716 }
717 case Instruction::ZExt: {
718 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
719 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000720 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000721
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000722 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
723 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
725 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
726 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000727 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
728 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000729 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
730 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000731 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000732 return;
733 }
734 case Instruction::SExt: {
735 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
736 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000737 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000738
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000739 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
740 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
742 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
743 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000744 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000745 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
746 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000747
748 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
749 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000750 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000751 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000752 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000753 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000754 return;
755 }
756 case Instruction::Shl:
757 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
758 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000759 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000760 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
761 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000762 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000763 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
764 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000765 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000766 return;
767 }
768 break;
769 case Instruction::LShr:
770 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
771 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
772 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000773 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000774
775 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000776 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
777 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000778 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
779 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
780 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000781 // high bits known zero.
782 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000783 return;
784 }
785 break;
786 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000787 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000788 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
789 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000790 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000791
792 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000793 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
794 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000795 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
796 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
797 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
798
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000799 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
800 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000801 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000802 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000803 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000804 return;
805 }
806 break;
807 }
808}
809
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000810/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
811/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
812/// for bits that V cannot have.
813static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000814 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000815 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
816 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
817 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
818}
819
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000820/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
821/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
822/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
823/// constant and return true.
824static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000825 APInt Demanded) {
826 assert(I && "No instruction?");
827 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
828
829 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
830 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
831 if (!OpC) return false;
832
833 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
834 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
835 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
836 return false;
837
838 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
839 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
840 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
841 return true;
842}
843
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000844// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
845// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
846// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
847// min/max.
848static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000849 const APInt& KnownZero,
850 const APInt& KnownOne,
851 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
852 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
853 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
855 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
856 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000857 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000859 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
860 // bit if it is unknown.
861 Min = KnownOne;
862 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
863
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000864 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000865 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
866 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000867 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000868}
869
870// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
871// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
872// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
873// min/max.
874static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000875 const APInt &KnownZero,
876 const APInt &KnownOne,
877 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
878 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000879 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
881 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
882 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000883 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000884
885 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
886 Min = KnownOne;
887 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
888 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
889}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000890
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000891/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
892/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
893/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
894/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
895/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
896/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
897/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
898/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
899/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
900/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
901/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
902/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
903/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
904/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
905/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
906bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
907 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
908 unsigned Depth) {
909 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
910 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
911 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
912 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
913 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
916 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
917 must have same BitWidth");
918 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
919 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
920 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
921 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
922 return false;
923 }
924
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000925 KnownZero.clear();
926 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000927 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
928 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
929 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
930 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
931 return false;
932 }
933 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
934 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
935 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
936 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
937 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
938 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
939 return false;
940 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
941 return false;
942 }
943
944 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
945 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
946
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000947 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
948 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
949 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
950 default: break;
951 case Instruction::And:
952 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
957 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
958
959 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
960 // LHS.
961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
962 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
963 return true;
964 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
965 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
966
967 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
968 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
969 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
970 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
971 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
972 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
973 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
974 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
975
976 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
977 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
978 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
979
980 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
981 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
982 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
983
984 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
985 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
986 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
987 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
988 break;
989 case Instruction::Or:
990 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
991 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
992 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
993 return true;
994 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
995 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
996 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
997 // LHS.
998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
999 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1000 return true;
1001 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1002 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1003
1004 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1005 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1006 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1007 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1008 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1009 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1010 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1011 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1012
1013 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1014 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1015 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1016 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1017 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1018 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1019 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1020 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1021
1022 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1023 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1024 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1025
1026 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1027 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1028 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1029 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1030 break;
1031 case Instruction::Xor: {
1032 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1033 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1034 return true;
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1038 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1039 return true;
1040 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1041 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1042
1043 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1044 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1045 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1046 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1047 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1048 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1049
1050 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1051 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1052 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1053 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1054 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1055 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1056
1057 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1058 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1059 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1060 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1061 Instruction *Or =
1062 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1063 I->getName());
1064 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1065 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1066 }
1067
1068 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1069 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1070 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1071 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1072 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1073 // all known
1074 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1075 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1076 Instruction *And =
1077 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1078 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1079 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1080 }
1081 }
1082
1083 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1084 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1085 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1086 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1087
1088 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1089 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1090 break;
1091 }
1092 case Instruction::Select:
1093 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1094 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1095 return true;
1096 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1097 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1098 return true;
1099 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1100 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1101 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1102 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1103
1104 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1105 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1106 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1111 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1112 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1113 break;
1114 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1115 uint32_t truncBf =
1116 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001117 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1119 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1120 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1121 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 return true;
1123 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1126 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1127 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1128 break;
1129 }
1130 case Instruction::BitCast:
1131 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1132 return false;
1133
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1135 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1138 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1139 break;
1140 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1141 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1142 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001143 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001145 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1147 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1149 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 return true;
1151 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1153 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1154 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1155 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1156 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001157 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001158 break;
1159 }
1160 case Instruction::SExt: {
1161 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1162 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001163 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001166 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001167
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001168 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1170 // bit is demanded.
1171 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001172 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001173
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001174 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1176 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001177 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1178 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179 return true;
1180 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1182 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1183 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1184 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1185
1186 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1187 // top bits of the result.
1188
1189 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1190 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001191 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001192 {
1193 // Convert to ZExt cast
1194 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1195 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001196 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001198 }
1199 break;
1200 }
1201 case Instruction::Add: {
1202 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1203 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1204 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001205 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001206
1207 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1208 // we can do.
1209 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1210 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1211 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1212 if (RHS->isZero())
1213 break;
1214
1215 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1216 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001217 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218
1219 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1220 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1221 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1222 return true;
1223
1224 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1225 // the constant.
1226 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1227 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1228
1229 // Avoid excess work.
1230 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1231 break;
1232
1233 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1234 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1235 Instruction *Or =
1236 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1237 I->getName());
1238 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1239 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1240 }
1241
1242 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1243 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1244 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1245 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1246 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1247
1248 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1249 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1250 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001251 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1252 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253
1254 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1255
1256 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1257 // other, and there is no input carry.
1258 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1259 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1260
1261 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1262 // is no input carry.
1263 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1264 } else {
1265 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1266 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001267 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1269 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001270 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001271 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1272 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1273 return true;
1274 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1275 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 break;
1280 }
1281 case Instruction::Sub:
1282 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1283 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001284 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001285 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1286 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001287 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001288 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001289 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1290 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1291 return true;
1292 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1293 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1294 return true;
1295 }
1296 break;
1297 case Instruction::Shl:
1298 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001299 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001300 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1301 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001302 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1303 return true;
1304 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1305 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1306 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1308 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001309 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001310 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311 }
1312 break;
1313 case Instruction::LShr:
1314 // For a logical shift right
1315 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001316 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001318 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001319 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1320 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001321 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1322 return true;
1323 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1324 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001325 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1326 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001327 if (ShiftAmt) {
1328 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001329 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001330 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1331 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001332 }
1333 break;
1334 case Instruction::AShr:
1335 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1336 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1337 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1338 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1339 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1340 // Perform the logical shift right.
1341 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1342 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1343 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1344 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1345 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001346
1347 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1348 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1349 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1350 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001351
1352 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001353 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001355 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001356 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001357 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1358 // demanded.
1359 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1360 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001361 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001362 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001363 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1364 return true;
1365 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1366 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1367 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001368 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001369 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1370 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1371
1372 // Handle the sign bits.
1373 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1374 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1375 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1376
1377 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1378 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001379 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001380 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1381 // Perform the logical shift right.
1382 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1383 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1384 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1385 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1386 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1387 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 break;
1391 }
1392
1393 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1394 // constant.
1395 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1396 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1397 return false;
1398}
1399
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001400
1401/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1402/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1403/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1404/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1405///
1406/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1407/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1408/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1409Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1410 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1411 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001412 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001413 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1414 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1415 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1416 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1417
1418 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1419 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1420 UndefElts = EltMask;
1421 return 0;
1422 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1423 UndefElts = EltMask;
1424 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1425 }
1426
1427 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001428 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1429 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001430 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1431
1432 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1433 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1434 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1435 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1436 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1437 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1438 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1439 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1440 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1441 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1442 }
1443
1444 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001445 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1447 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001448 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001450 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001451 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1452 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1453 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1454 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1455 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1456 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001457 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001458 }
1459
1460 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1461 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1462 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1463 return false;
1464 }
1465 return false;
1466 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1467 return false;
1468 }
1469
1470 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1471 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1472
1473 bool MadeChange = false;
1474 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1475 Value *TmpV;
1476 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1477 default: break;
1478
1479 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1480 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1481 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001482 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001483 if (Idx == 0) {
1484 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1485 // which elt is getting updated.
1486 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1487 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1488 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1489 break;
1490 }
1491
1492 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1493 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001494 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001495 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1496 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1497
1498 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1499 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1500 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1501 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1502 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1503 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1504
1505 // The inserted element is defined.
1506 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1507 break;
1508 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001509 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001510 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001511 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1512 if (!VTy) break;
1513 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1514 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1515 unsigned Ratio;
1516
1517 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001518 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001519 // elements as are demanded of us.
1520 Ratio = 1;
1521 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1522 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1523 // Untested so far.
1524 break;
1525
1526 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1527 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1528 // elements are live.
1529 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1530 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1531 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1532 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1533 }
1534 } else {
1535 // Untested so far.
1536 break;
1537
1538 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1539 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1540 // live.
1541 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1542 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1543 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1544 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1545 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001546
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001547 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1548 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1549 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1550 if (TmpV) {
1551 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1552 MadeChange = true;
1553 }
1554
1555 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1556 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1557 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1558 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1559 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1560 // undef.
1561 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1562 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1563 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1564 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1565 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1566 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1567 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1568 // elements are undef.
1569 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1570 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1571 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1572 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1573 }
1574 break;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576 case Instruction::And:
1577 case Instruction::Or:
1578 case Instruction::Xor:
1579 case Instruction::Add:
1580 case Instruction::Sub:
1581 case Instruction::Mul:
1582 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1583 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1584 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1585 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1587 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1589
1590 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1591 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1592 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1593 break;
1594
1595 case Instruction::Call: {
1596 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1597 if (!II) break;
1598 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1599 default: break;
1600
1601 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1602 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1610 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1611 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1612 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1613 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1614 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1615 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1616 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1617
1618 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1619 // scalarize it now.
1620 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1621 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1622 default: break;
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1626 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1627 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1628 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1629 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1630 // Extract the element as scalars.
1631 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1633
1634 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1635 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1639 II->getName()), *II);
1640 break;
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1643 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1644 II->getName()), *II);
1645 break;
1646 }
1647
1648 Instruction *New =
1649 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1650 II->getName());
1651 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1652 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1653 return New;
1654 }
1655 }
1656
1657 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1658 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1659 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1660 break;
1661 }
1662 break;
1663 }
1664 }
1665 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1666}
1667
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001668/// @returns true if the specified compare predicate is
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001669/// true when both operands are equal...
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001670/// @brief Determine if the icmp Predicate is true when both operands are equal
1671static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst::Predicate pred) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001672 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1674 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1675}
1676
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001677/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1678/// true when both operands are equal...
1679/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true when both operands are equal
1680static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1681 return isTrueWhenEqual(ICI.getPredicate());
1682}
1683
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001684/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1685/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1686/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1687/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1688/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1689/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1690/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1691///
1692template<typename Functor>
1693Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1694 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1695 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1696
1697 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1698 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1699 return F.apply(Root);
1700
1701 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1702 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001703 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001704 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1705 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1706
1707 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1708 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1709 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1710 ShouldApply = true;
1711 }
1712
1713 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1714 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1715 if (ShouldApply) {
1716 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001717
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001718 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1719 // and perform the reassociation.
1720 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1721
1722 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1723 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1724
1725 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1726 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001727 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001728 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1729 return 0;
1730 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001731 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001732 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001733 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1734 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1735 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1736 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001737
1738 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1739 // get to LHSI.
1740 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1741 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001742 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1743 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1744 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1745 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1746 ARI = NextLHSI;
1747
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001748 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1749 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1750 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1751 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1752 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001753
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001754 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1755 // the transformation...
1756 return F.apply(Root);
1757 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1760 }
1761 return 0;
1762}
1763
1764
1765// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1766struct AddRHS {
1767 Value *RHS;
1768 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1769 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1770 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001771 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001772 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001773 }
1774};
1775
1776// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1777// iff C1&C2 == 0
1778struct AddMaskingAnd {
1779 Constant *C2;
1780 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001782 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001783 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001784 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001787 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001788 }
1789};
1790
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001791static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001792 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001793 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001794 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001795 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001796
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001797 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1798 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001799 }
1800
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001801 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001802 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1803 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001804
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001805 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1806 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001807 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1808 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001809 }
1810
1811 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1812 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1813 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1814 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001815 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1816 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001817 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1818 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1819 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001820 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001821 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001822 abort();
1823 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001824 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1825}
1826
1827// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1828// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1829// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1830// not have a second operand.
1831static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1832 InstCombiner *IC) {
1833 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1834 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1835 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1836 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1837
1838 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001839 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001840 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001841
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001842 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1843 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1844
1845 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1846 SelectFalseVal);
1847 }
1848 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001849}
1850
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001851
1852/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1853/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1854/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1855Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1856 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001857 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001858 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001859
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001860 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1861 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001862 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001863 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1864 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1865 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1866 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001867 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001868 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1869
1870 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1871 // loop.
1872 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1873 return 0;
1874 }
1875
1876 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1877 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1878 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1879 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1880 if (NonConstBB) {
1881 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1882 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1883 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001884
1885 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001886 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001887 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001888 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001889 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001890
1891 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1892 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1893 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001894 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001895 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001896 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001897 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1898 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1899 else
1900 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001901 } else {
1902 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1903 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1904 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1905 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1906 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001907 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1908 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1909 CI->getPredicate(),
1910 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1911 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001912 else
1913 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1914
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001915 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 }
1917 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001918 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001919 } else {
1920 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1921 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001922 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001923 Value *InV;
1924 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001925 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 } else {
1927 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001928 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1929 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1930 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001931 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001932 }
1933 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001934 }
1935 }
1936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1937}
1938
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001939Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001940 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001941 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001942
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001943 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001944 // X + undef -> undef
1945 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1947
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001948 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001949 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001950 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1951 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001952 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001953 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1954 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001956 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001957
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001958 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001959 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001960 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001961 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001962 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001963 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001964
1965 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1966 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001967 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1968 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1969 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1970 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1971 return &I;
1972 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001973 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001974
1975 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1976 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1977 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001978
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001979 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1980 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001981 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1982 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001983 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001984 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001985
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001986 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001987 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1988 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001989 do {
1990 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001991 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1992 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001993 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1994 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001995 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001996 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1997 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001999 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002000 }
2001 }
2002 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002003 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2004 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2005 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002006
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002007 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2008 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2009 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2010 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2011 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2012 switch (Size) {
2013 default: break;
2014 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2015 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2016 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2017 }
2018 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002019 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002021 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002022 }
2023 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002024 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002025
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002026 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002027 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002028 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002029
2030 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2031 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2032 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2034 }
2035 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2036 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2037 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2039 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002040 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002041
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002042 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002043 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002044 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002045
2046 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002047 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2048 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002049 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002050
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002051
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002052 ConstantInt *C2;
2053 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2054 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2055 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2056
2057 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2058 ConstantInt *C1;
2059 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002060 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002061 }
2062
2063 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002064 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2065 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2066
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002067 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002068 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002070
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002071
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002072 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002073 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002074 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2075 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002076
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002077 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002078 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002079 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2080 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002081
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002082 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2083 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002084 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002085 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2086 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2087 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002088 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002089
2090 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002091 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002092
2093 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002094 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002095
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002096 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2097 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2098 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2099 LHS->getName()), I);
2100 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2101 }
2102 }
2103 }
2104
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002105 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2106 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002107 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002108 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002109 }
2110
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002111 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002112 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002113 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002114 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2115 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002116 if (!CI) {
2117 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2118 Other = LHS;
2119 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002120 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002121 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2122 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002123 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002124 unsigned AS =
2125 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002126 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002127 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002128 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002129 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002130 }
2131 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002132
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002133 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002134 {
2135 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2136 Value *Other = RHS;
2137 if (!SI) {
2138 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2139 Other = LHS;
2140 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002141 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002142 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2143 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002144 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002145
2146 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2147 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002148 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2149 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
2150 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
2151 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2152 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
2153 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002154 }
2155 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002156
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002157 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002158}
2159
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002160// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2161// highest order bit set.
2162static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002163 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002164 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002165}
2166
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002167Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002168 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002169
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002170 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002172
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002173 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002174 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002175 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002176
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002177 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2179 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2180 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2181
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002182 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2183 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002184 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2185 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002186
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002187 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002188 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002189 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002190 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2191
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002192 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2193 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002194 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002195 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002196 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002197 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002198 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002199 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002200 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002201 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002202 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2203 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002204 }
2205 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002206 }
2207 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2208 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2209 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002210 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002211 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002212 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002213 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002214 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002215 }
2216 }
2217 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002218 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002219
2220 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2221 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002222 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002223 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002224
2225 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2226 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2227 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002228 }
2229
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002230 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2231 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002232 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002233 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002234 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002235 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002236 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002237 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2238 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2239 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002240 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002241 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2242 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002243 }
2244
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002245 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002246 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2247 // is not used by anyone else...
2248 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002249 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002250 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002251 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2252 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2253 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2254 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002255
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002256 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002257 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002258 }
2259
2260 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2261 //
2262 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2263 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2264 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2265
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002266 Value *NewNot =
2267 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002268 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002269 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002270
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002271 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002272 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002273 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002274 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002275 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002276 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002277 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2278
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002279 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002280 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002281 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002282 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002283 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002284 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002285
2286 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2287 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2288 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2289 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2290 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2291 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
2292 return BinaryOperator::createSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2293 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2294 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2295 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002296 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002297 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002298
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002299 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002300 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2301 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002302 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2304 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002306 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2307 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2308 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002309 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002310
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002311 ConstantInt *C1;
2312 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002313 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2314 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002315
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002316 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2317 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002318 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002319 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002320 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002321}
2322
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002323/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2324/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2325/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2326/// signed.
2327static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2328 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002329 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2331 TrueIfSigned = true;
2332 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002333 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2334 TrueIfSigned = true;
2335 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002336 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2337 TrueIfSigned = false;
2338 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2340 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2341 TrueIfSigned = true;
2342 return RHS->getValue() ==
2343 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2345 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2346 TrueIfSigned = true;
2347 return RHS->getValue() ==
2348 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002349 default:
2350 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002351 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002352}
2353
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002354Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002355 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002356 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002357
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002358 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2360
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002361 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002362 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2363 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002364
2365 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002366 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002367 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2368 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002369 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2370 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002371
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002372 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2374 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2376 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002377 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002378
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002379 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002380 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002381 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002382 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002383 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002384 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002385 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2386 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002387
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002388 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2389 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002390 // We need a better interface for long double here.
2391 if (Op1->getType() == Type::FloatTy || Op1->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
2392 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002394 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002395
2396 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2397 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2398 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2399 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2400 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2401 Op1, "tmp");
2402 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2403 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2404 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2405 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2406
2407 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002408
2409 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2410 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002411 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002412 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002413
2414 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2415 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2416 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002417 }
2418
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002419 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2420 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002421 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002422
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002423 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2424 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2425 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2426 // formed.
2427 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002428 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002429 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002430 BoolCast = CI;
2431 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002432 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002433 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002434 BoolCast = CI;
2435 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002436 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002437 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2438 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002439 bool TIS = false;
2440
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002441 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002442 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2443 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002444 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2445 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002446 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002447 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002448 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002449 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002450 InsertNewInstBefore(
2451 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002452 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2453 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002454
2455 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2456 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002457 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002458 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2459 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002460 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2461 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2462 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2463 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2464 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002465
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002466 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002467 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002468 }
2469 }
2470 }
2471
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002472 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002473}
2474
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002475/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2476/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2477/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2478/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002479Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002480 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002481
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002482 // undef / X -> 0
2483 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002485
2486 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002487 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002489
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002490 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002491 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2492 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002493 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2494 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002495 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002496 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002497 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2498 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2499 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2500 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002501 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002502 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2503 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2504 else
2505 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2506 return &I;
2507 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002508
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002509 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2510 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2511 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2512 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2513 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002514 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002515 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2516 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2517 else
2518 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2519 return &I;
2520 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002521 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002522
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002523 return 0;
2524}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002525
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002526/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2527/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2528/// division instructions.
2529/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002530Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002531 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2532
2533 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2534 return Common;
2535
2536 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2537 // div X, 1 == X
2538 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2539 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2540
2541 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2542 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2543 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2544 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2545 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002546 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002547 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002548
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002549 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002550 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2551 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2552 return R;
2553 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2554 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2555 return NV;
2556 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002557 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002558
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002559 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002560 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002561 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2563
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002564 return 0;
2565}
2566
2567Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2568 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2569
2570 // Handle the integer div common cases
2571 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2572 return Common;
2573
2574 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2575 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2576 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2577 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002578 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002579 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002580 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002581 }
2582
2583 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002584 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002585 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2586 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002587 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002588 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002589 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002590 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002591 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002592 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2593 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002594 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002595 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002596 }
2597 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002598 }
2599
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002600 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2601 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002602 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002603 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002604 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002605 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002606 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002607 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002608 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002609 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2610 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2611 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2612 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2613 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2614
2615 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2616 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2617 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2618 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2619 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002620
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002621 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2622 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002623 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002624 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002625 return 0;
2626}
2627
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002628Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2629 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2630
2631 // Handle the integer div common cases
2632 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2633 return Common;
2634
2635 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2636 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2637 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2638 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2639
2640 // -X/C -> X/-C
2641 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2642 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2643 }
2644
2645 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2646 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002647 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002648 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002649 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002650 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002651 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2652 }
2653 }
2654
2655 return 0;
2656}
2657
2658Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2659 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2660}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002661
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002662/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2663/// of some factor, return that factor.
2664static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2665 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2666 return CI;
2667
2668 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2669 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2670
2671 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2672 if (!I) return Result;
2673
2674 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2675 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2676 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2677 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2678 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2679 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2680 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2681 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2682 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2683 }
2684 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2685 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2686 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002687 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattner148083a2007-11-23 22:35:18 +00002688 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())// don't shift by "32"
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002689 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002690 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002691 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002692 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002693 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002694 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2695 return Result;
2696 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2697 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002698 }
2699 return Result;
2700}
2701
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002702/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2703/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2704/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2705/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2706Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002707 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002708
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002709 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2710 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2711 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2713
2714 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2715 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2716 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002718
2719 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2720 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2721 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2722 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2723 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2724 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2725 // simplified also.
2726 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2727 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2728 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2729 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002730 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002731 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2732 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2733 else
2734 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002735 return &I;
2736 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002737 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2738 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2739 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2740 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2741 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002742 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002743 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2744 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2745 else
2746 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2747 return &I;
2748 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002749 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002750
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002751 return 0;
2752}
2753
2754/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2755/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2756/// remainder instructions.
2757/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2758Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2759 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2760
2761 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2762 return common;
2763
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002764 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002765 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2766 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2768
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002769 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2771
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002772 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2773 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2774 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2775 return R;
2776 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2777 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2778 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002779 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002780 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2781 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002783 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002784 }
2785
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002786 return 0;
2787}
2788
2789Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2790 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2791
2792 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2793 return common;
2794
2795 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2796 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2797 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2798 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2799 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002800 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002801 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2802 }
2803
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002804 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002805 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2806 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2807 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002808 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002809 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2810 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2811 "tmp"), I);
2812 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2813 }
2814 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002815 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002816
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002817 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2818 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2819 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2820 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2821 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2822 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002823 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2824 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002825 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2826 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2827 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2828 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2829 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2830 }
2831 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002832 }
2833
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002834 return 0;
2835}
2836
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002837Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2838 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2839
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002840 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002841 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2842 return common;
2843
2844 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2845 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002846 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002847 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2848 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2849 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2850 return &I;
2851 }
2852
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002853 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002854 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002855 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2856 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2857 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2858 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2859 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2860 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002861 }
2862
2863 return 0;
2864}
2865
2866Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002867 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2868}
2869
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002870// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002871static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002872 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002873 if (!isSigned)
2874 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2875 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002876}
2877
2878// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002879static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002880 if (!isSigned)
2881 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2882
2883 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2884 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2885 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002886}
2887
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002888// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2889// constant.
2890static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002891 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002892}
2893
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002894// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2895// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2896static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002897 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002898}
2899
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002900/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002901/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2902///
2903/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2904///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002905/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2906/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002907///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002908/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2909/// 0 A > B
2910/// 1 A == B
2911/// 2 A < B
2912///
2913/// <=> Value Definition
2914/// 000 0 Always false
2915/// 001 1 A > B
2916/// 010 2 A == B
2917/// 011 3 A >= B
2918/// 100 4 A < B
2919/// 101 5 A != B
2920/// 110 6 A <= B
2921/// 111 7 Always true
2922///
2923static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2924 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002925 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002926 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2931 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002936 // True -> 7
2937 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002938 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002939 return 0;
2940 }
2941}
2942
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002943/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2944/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002945/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002946/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2947static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2948 switch (code) {
2949 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002950 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002951 case 1:
2952 if (sign)
2953 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2954 else
2955 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2956 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2957 case 3:
2958 if (sign)
2959 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2960 else
2961 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2962 case 4:
2963 if (sign)
2964 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2965 else
2966 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2967 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2968 case 6:
2969 if (sign)
2970 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2971 else
2972 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002973 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002974 }
2975}
2976
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002977static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2978 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2979 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2980 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2981 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2982 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2983}
2984
2985namespace {
2986// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2987struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002988 InstCombiner &IC;
2989 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002990 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2991 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2992 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2993 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002994 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002995 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2996 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2997 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2998 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002999 return false;
3000 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003001 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3002 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3003 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3004 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3005 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003006 }
3007
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003008 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003009 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003010 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003011 unsigned Code;
3012 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3013 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3014 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3015 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003016 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003017 }
3018
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003019 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3020 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3021
3022 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003023 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3024 return I;
3025 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3026 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3027 }
3028};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003029} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003030
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003031// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3032// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003033// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003034Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003035 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3036 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003037 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3038 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003039 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003040 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003041 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003042
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003043 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3044 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003045 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003046 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003047 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003048 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003049 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003050 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003051 }
3052 break;
3053 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003054 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3055 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003056
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003057 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3058 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003059 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003060 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003061 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003062 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003063 }
3064 break;
3065 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003066 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003067 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3068 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3069 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003070 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003071
3072 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003073 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003074 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3075 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3076 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003077 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003078
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003079 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3080 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3081 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3082 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3083 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3084 // no effect.
3085 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3086 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3087 return &TheAnd;
3088 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003089 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003090 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003091 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003092 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003093 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003094 }
3095 }
3096 }
3097 }
3098 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003099
3100 case Instruction::Shl: {
3101 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3102 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3103 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003104 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003105 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003106 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3107 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003108
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003109 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3110 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003111 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3112 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003113 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3114 return &TheAnd;
3115 }
3116 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003117 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003118 case Instruction::LShr:
3119 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003120 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3121 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3122 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3123 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003124 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003125 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003126 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3127 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003128
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003129 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3130 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003131 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3132 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3133 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3134 return &TheAnd;
3135 }
3136 break;
3137 }
3138 case Instruction::AShr:
3139 // Signed shr.
3140 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3141 // with an and.
3142 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003143 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003144 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003145 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3146 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003147 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003148 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003149 // Make the argument unsigned.
3150 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003151 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003152 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003153 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003154 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003155 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003156 }
3157 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003158 }
3159 return 0;
3160}
3161
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003162
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003163/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3164/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003165/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3166/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003167/// insert new instructions.
3168Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003169 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3170 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003171 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003172 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003173 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003174
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003175 if (Inside) {
3176 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003177 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003178
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003179 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003180 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003181 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003182 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3183 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3184 }
3185
3186 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3187 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3188 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003189 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003190 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3191 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003192 }
3193
3194 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003195 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003196
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003197 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003198 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003199 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003200 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3201 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3202 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3203 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003204
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003205 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3206 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3207 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003208 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003209 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003210 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3211 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003212}
3213
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003214// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3215// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3216// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3217// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003218static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003219 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003220 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3221 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003222
3223 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003224 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003225 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003226 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003227 return true;
3228}
3229
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003230/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3231/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3232/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003233///
3234/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3235/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3236/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3237///
3238/// return (A +/- B).
3239///
3240Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003241 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003242 Instruction &I) {
3243 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3244 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3245 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3246
3247 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3248
3249 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3250 default: return 0;
3251 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003252 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003253 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003254 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3255 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3256 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003257 break;
3258
3259 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3260 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3261 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003262 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003263 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003264 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003265 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003266 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003267 break;
3268 }
3269 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003270 return 0;
3271 case Instruction::Or:
3272 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003273 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003274 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3275 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003276 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003277 break;
3278 return 0;
3279 }
3280
3281 Instruction *New;
3282 if (isSub)
3283 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3284 else
3285 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3286 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3287}
3288
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003289Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003290 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003291 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003292
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003293 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3295
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003296 // and X, X = X
3297 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003298 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003299
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003300 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003301 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003302 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003303 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3304 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003306 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003307 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003308 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003309 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003310 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003312 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3313 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003314 }
3315 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003316
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003317 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003318 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3319 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003320
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003321 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003322 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003323 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003324 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3325 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3326 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3327 case Instruction::Xor:
3328 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003329 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3330 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3331 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3332 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3333 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3334 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3335 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3336 return BinaryOperator::create(
3337 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003338 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003339 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003340 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3341 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3342 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3343 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3345 return BinaryOperator::create(
3346 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3347 }
3348 }
3349
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003350 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003351 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003352 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3353 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3354 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3355 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3356 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3357 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3358 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003359 break;
3360
3361 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003362 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3363 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3364 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3365 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3366 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003367 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003368 }
3369
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003370 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003371 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003372 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003373 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003374 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3375 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3376 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3377 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003378 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003379 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003380 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003381 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3382 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003383 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3384 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3385 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003386 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3387 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3388 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003389 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003390 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003391 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003392 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003393 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3394 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3395 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3396 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003397 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003398 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3400 }
3401 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003402 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003403
3404 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3405 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003406 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003407 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003408 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3409 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3410 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003411 }
3412
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003413 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3414 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003415
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003416 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3418
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003419 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003420 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003421 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3422 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003423 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003424 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3425 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003426
3427 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003428 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3429 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003430 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3431 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003432
3433 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3434 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3435 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3436 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3437 }
3438 }
3439
3440 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003441 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003443
3444 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3445 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3446 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3447 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3448 }
3449 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003450
3451 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3452 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3453 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3454 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3455 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3456 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3457 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3458 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3459 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3460 }
3461 }
3462 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3463 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3464 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3465 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3466 std::swap(A, B);
3467 }
3468 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3469 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3470 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3471 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3472 }
3473 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003474 }
3475
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003476 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3477 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3478 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003479 return R;
3480
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003481 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3482 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003483 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3484 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3485 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3486 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3487 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3488 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3489 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3490 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003491 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3492
3493 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3494 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3495 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3496 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003497 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003498 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3499 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3500 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3501 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003502 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003503 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3504 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3505 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3506 }
3507
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003508 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003509 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3510 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003511 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3512 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3513 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003514 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3515
3516 switch (LHSCC) {
3517 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003518 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003519 switch (RHSCC) {
3520 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003524 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3529 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003531 switch (RHSCC) {
3532 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3534 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3535 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3536 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3537 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3538 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3539 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3540 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3543 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3546 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003547 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3548 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3549 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3550 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003551 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3552 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003553 }
3554 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3555 }
3556 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003558 switch (RHSCC) {
3559 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3564 break;
3565 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003567 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3569 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003570 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003571 break;
3572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003573 switch (RHSCC) {
3574 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3579 break;
3580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3581 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003583 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3584 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003585 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003586 break;
3587 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3588 switch (RHSCC) {
3589 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3590 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3591 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3594 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3595 break;
3596 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3597 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3598 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3599 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3600 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3601 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3602 true, I);
3603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3604 break;
3605 }
3606 break;
3607 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3608 switch (RHSCC) {
3609 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003610 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003611 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3612 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3614 break;
3615 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3616 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3617 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3618 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3619 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3620 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3621 true, I);
3622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3623 break;
3624 }
3625 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003626 }
3627 }
3628 }
3629
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003630 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003631 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3632 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3633 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3634 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003635 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003636 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003637 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3638 I.getType(), TD) &&
3639 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3640 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003641 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3642 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3643 I.getName());
3644 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3645 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3646 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003647 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003648
3649 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003650 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3651 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3652 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003653 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3654 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3655 Instruction *NewOp =
3656 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3657 SI1->getOperand(0),
3658 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003659 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3660 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003661 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003662 }
3663
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003664 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3665 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3666 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3667 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3668 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3669 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3670 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3671 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3672 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003673 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3675 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3676 RHS->getOperand(0));
3677 }
3678 }
3679 }
3680
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003681 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003682}
3683
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003684/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3685/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3686/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003687static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003688 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3689 if (I == 0) return true;
3690
3691 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3692 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3693 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3694 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3695
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003696 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003697 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3698 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003699 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003700 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003701 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003702 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3703 return true;
3704
3705 unsigned DestNo;
3706 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3707 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3708 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3709 } else {
3710 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3711 DestNo = 0;
3712 }
3713
3714 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3715 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3716 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3717 return true;
3718 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3719 return false;
3720 }
3721
3722 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3723 // don't have this.
3724 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3725 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3726 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3727 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3728 return true;
3729 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3730
3731 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003732 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3733 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003734 return true;
3735
3736 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3737 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003738 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3739 return true;
3740 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003741 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003742 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003743 break;
3744 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3745 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3746
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003747 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003748 unsigned SrcByte;
3749 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3750 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3751 else
3752 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3753
3754 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3755 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3756 return true;
3757
3758 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3759 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3760 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3761 return true;
3762 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3763 return false;
3764}
3765
3766/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3767/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3768Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003769 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3770 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3771 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003772
3773 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3774 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003775 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003776 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003777
3778 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3779 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3780 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3781 return 0;
3782
3783 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3784 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3785 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3786
3787 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3788 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3789 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3790 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003791 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003792 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003793 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003794 return new CallInst(F, V);
3795}
3796
3797
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003798Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003799 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003800 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003801
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003802 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003804
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003805 // or X, X = X
3806 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003808
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003809 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3810 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003811 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3812 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3813 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3814 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3815 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3816 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003817 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3818 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3819 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3820 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003822 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003823
3824
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003825
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003826 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003827 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003828 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003829 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3830 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003831 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003832 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003833 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003834 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3835 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003836 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003837
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003838 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3839 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003840 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003841 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003842 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003843 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003844 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003845 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003846
3847 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3848 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003849 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003850 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003851 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3852 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3853 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003854 }
3855
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003856 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3857 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003858
3859 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3860 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3861 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3862 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3863 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3865
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003866 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3867 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003868 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003869 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3870 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3871 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003872 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3873 return BSwap;
3874 }
3875
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003876 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3877 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003878 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003879 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3880 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3881 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3882 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003883 }
3884
3885 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3886 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003887 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003888 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3889 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3890 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3891 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003892 }
3893
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003894 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003895 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003896 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3897 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003898 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3899 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3900 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3901 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3902 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3903 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3904 // replace with V+N.
3905 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3906 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3907 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3908 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3909 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3911 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3913 }
3914 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3915 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3916 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3917 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3918 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3920 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3922 }
3923 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003924 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003925 }
3926
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003927 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3928 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003929 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3930 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3931 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3932 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3933 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3934 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3935 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3936 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3937 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3938
3939 if (V1) {
3940 Value *Or =
3941 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3942 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003943 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003944 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003945 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003946
3947 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003948 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3949 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3950 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003951 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3952 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3953 Instruction *NewOp =
3954 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3955 SI1->getOperand(0),
3956 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003957 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3958 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003959 }
3960 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003961
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003962 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3963 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003965 } else {
3966 A = 0;
3967 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003968 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003969 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3970 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003972
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003973 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003974 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3975 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3976 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3977 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3978 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003979 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003980
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003981 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3982 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3983 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003984 return R;
3985
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003986 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3987 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003988 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3989 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3990 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3991 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3992 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3993 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3994 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3995 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003996 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3997 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3998 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003999 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004000 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004001 bool NeedsSwap;
4002 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004003 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004004 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004005 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004006
4007 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004008 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4009 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4010 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4011 }
4012
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004013 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004014 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4015 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004016 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4017 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004018 // equal.
4019 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4020
4021 switch (LHSCC) {
4022 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004023 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004024 switch (RHSCC) {
4025 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004027 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4028 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4029 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
4030 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4031 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004032 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004033 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004034 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004035 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4037 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004038 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004039 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4040 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4041 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004042 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4043 }
4044 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004045 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004046 switch (RHSCC) {
4047 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4049 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4050 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004051 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004052 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4053 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4054 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004055 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004056 }
4057 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004058 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004059 switch (RHSCC) {
4060 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004061 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004062 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004063 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004064 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4065 // this can cause overflow.
4066 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004068 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4069 false, I);
4070 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4071 break;
4072 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4073 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004075 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4076 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004077 }
4078 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004079 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004080 switch (RHSCC) {
4081 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004082 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4083 break;
4084 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004085 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4086 // this can cause overflow.
4087 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4088 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004089 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4090 false, I);
4091 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4092 break;
4093 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4094 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4096 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4097 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004098 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004099 break;
4100 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4101 switch (RHSCC) {
4102 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4103 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4104 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4106 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4107 break;
4108 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4109 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004111 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4112 break;
4113 }
4114 break;
4115 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4116 switch (RHSCC) {
4117 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4118 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4119 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4120 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4122 break;
4123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004125 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4127 break;
4128 }
4129 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004130 }
4131 }
4132 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004133
4134 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004135 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004136 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004137 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4138 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004139 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004140 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004141 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4142 I.getType(), TD) &&
4143 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4144 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004145 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4146 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4147 I.getName());
4148 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4149 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4150 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004151 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004152 }
4153
4154
4155 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4156 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4157 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4158 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4159 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO)
4160 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4161 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4162 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4163 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004164 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4166
4167 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4168 // rest.
4169 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4170 RHS->getOperand(0));
4171 }
4172 }
4173 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004174
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004175 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004176}
4177
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004178// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4179struct XorSelf {
4180 Value *RHS;
4181 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4182 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4183 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4184 return &Xor;
4185 }
4186};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004187
4188
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004189Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004190 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004191 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004192
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004193 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4195
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004196 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4197 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004198 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004199 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004200 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004201
4202 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4203 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004204 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4205 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4206 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4207 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4208 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4209 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004210 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004212 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004213
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004214 // Is this a ~ operation?
4215 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4216 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4217 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4218 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4219 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4220 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4221 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4222 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4223 Instruction *NotY =
4224 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4225 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4226 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4227 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4228 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4229 else
4230 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4231 }
4232 }
4233 }
4234 }
4235
4236
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004237 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004238 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4239 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4240 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004241 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4242 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004243
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004244 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4245 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4246 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4247 }
4248
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004249 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004250 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004251 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4252 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004253 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4254 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004255 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004256 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004257 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004258
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004259 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004260 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004261 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004262 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004263 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4264 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4265 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004266 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004267 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004268 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004269 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4270 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4271 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004272
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004273 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004274 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4275 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004276 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004277 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4278 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4279 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004280 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004281 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4282 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004283 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004284 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4285 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4286 return &I;
4287 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004288 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004289 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004290
4291 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4292 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004293 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004294 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004295 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4296 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4297 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004298 }
4299
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004300 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004301 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004302 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004303
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004304 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004305 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004307
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004308
4309 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4310 if (Op1I) {
4311 Value *A, *B;
4312 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4313 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004314 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004315 I.swapOperands();
4316 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004317 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004318 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004319 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004320 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004321 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4322 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4324 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4326 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004327 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004328 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004329 std::swap(A, B);
4330 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004331 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004332 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4333 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4334 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004335 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004336 }
4337
4338 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4339 if (Op0I) {
4340 Value *A, *B;
4341 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4342 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4343 std::swap(A, B);
4344 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4345 Instruction *NotB =
4346 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4347 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004348 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004349 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4350 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4352 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4354 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4355 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4356 std::swap(A, B);
4357 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004358 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004359 Instruction *N =
4360 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004361 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4362 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004363 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004364 }
4365
4366 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4367 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4368 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4369 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4370 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4371 Instruction *NewOp =
4372 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4373 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4374 Op0I->getName()), I);
4375 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4376 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4377 }
4378
4379 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4380 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4381 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4382 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4383 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4384 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4385 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4386 }
4387 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4388 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4389 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4390 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4391 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4392 }
4393
4394 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4395 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4396 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4397 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4398 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4399 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4400 if (A == C)
4401 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4402 else if (A == D)
4403 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4404 else if (B == C)
4405 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4406 else if (B == D)
4407 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4408
4409 if (X) {
4410 Instruction *NewOp =
4411 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4412 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4413 }
4414 }
4415 }
4416
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004417 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4418 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4419 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004420 return R;
4421
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004422 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004423 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004424 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004425 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4426 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004427 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004428 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004429 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4430 I.getType(), TD) &&
4431 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4432 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004433 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4434 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4435 I.getName());
4436 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4437 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4438 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004439 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004440 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004441 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004442}
4443
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004444/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4445/// overflowed for this type.
4446static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004447 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004448 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004449
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004450 if (IsSigned)
4451 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4452 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4453 else
4454 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4455 else
4456 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004457}
4458
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004459/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4460/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4461/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4462static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4463 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4464 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004465 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4466 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004467
4468 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004469 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4470 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004471
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004472 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4473 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004474 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004475 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4476 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4477
4478 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4479 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4480 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4481
4482 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4483 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004484 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004485 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4486 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4487 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4488 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4489 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004490 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004491
4492 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4493 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4494 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4495 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4496 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4497 else {
4498 // Emit an add instruction.
4499 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4500 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4501 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004502 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004503 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004504 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004505 // Convert to correct type.
4506 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4507 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4508 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4509 else
4510 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4511 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4512 }
4513 if (Size != 1) {
4514 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4515 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4516 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4517 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4518 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4519 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4520 }
4521
4522 // Emit an add instruction.
4523 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4524 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4525 cast<Constant>(Result));
4526 else
4527 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4528 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004529 }
4530 return Result;
4531}
4532
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004533/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004534/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004535Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4536 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4537 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004538 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004539
4540 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4541 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4542 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4543
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004544 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4545 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4546 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004547 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4548 // each index is zero or not.
4549 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004550 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004551 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4552 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004553 bool EmitIt = true;
4554 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4555 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4557 if (C->isNullValue())
4558 EmitIt = false;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004559 else if (TD->getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004560 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004561 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004563 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4564 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004565 }
4566
4567 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004568 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004569 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004570 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4571 if (InVal == 0)
4572 InVal = Comp;
4573 else {
4574 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4575 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004576 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004577 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4578 else // True if all are equal
4579 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4580 }
4581 }
4582 }
4583
4584 if (InVal)
4585 return InVal;
4586 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004587 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004588 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4589 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004590 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004591
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004592 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004593 // the result to fold to a constant!
4594 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4595 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4596 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004597 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4598 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004599 }
4600 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004601 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4602 // compare the base pointer.
4603 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4604 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004605 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004606 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004607 if (IndicesTheSame)
4608 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4609 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4610 IndicesTheSame = false;
4611 break;
4612 }
4613
4614 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4615 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004616 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4617 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004618
4619 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4620 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004621 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004622 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004623
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004624 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4625 bool AllZeros = true;
4626 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4627 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4628 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4629 AllZeros = false;
4630 break;
4631 }
4632 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004633 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4634 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004635
4636 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004637 AllZeros = true;
4638 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4639 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4640 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4641 AllZeros = false;
4642 break;
4643 }
4644 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004645 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004646
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004647 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4648 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4649 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4650 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4651 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4652 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004653 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4654 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004655 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004656 NumDifferences = 2;
4657 break;
4658 } else {
4659 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4660 DiffOperand = i;
4661 }
4662 }
4663
4664 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004666 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4667 isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
4668
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004669 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004670 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4671 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004672 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4673 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004674 }
4675 }
4676
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004677 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004678 // the result to fold to a constant!
4679 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4680 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4681 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4682 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4683 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004684 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004685 }
4686 }
4687 return 0;
4688}
4689
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004690Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4691 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004692 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004693
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004694 // Fold trivial predicates.
4695 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4697 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4699
4700 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4701 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4702 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4703 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4704 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4705 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4706 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4708 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4709 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4710 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4712
4713 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4714 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4715 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4716 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4717 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4718 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4719 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4720 return &I;
4721
4722 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4723 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4724 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4725 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4726 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4727 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4728 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4729 return &I;
4730 }
4731 }
4732
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004733 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004735
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004736 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4737 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4738 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4739 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4740 case Instruction::PHI:
4741 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4742 return NV;
4743 break;
4744 case Instruction::Select:
4745 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4746 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4747 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4748 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4749 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4750 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4751 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4752 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4753 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4754 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4755 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4756 I.getName()), I);
4757 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4758 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4759 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4760 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4761 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4762 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4763 I.getName()), I);
4764 }
4765 }
4766
4767 if (Op1)
4768 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4769 break;
4770 }
4771 }
4772
4773 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4774}
4775
4776Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4777 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4778 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4779 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4780
4781 // icmp X, X
4782 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4784 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004785
4786 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00004788
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004789 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004790 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004791 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4792 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4793 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004794 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4796 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004797
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004798 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004799 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004800 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4801 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4802 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004803 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004804 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004805 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004806 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004807 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004808 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004809
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4811 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4812 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004813 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004816 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4817 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4818 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4819 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4821 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4822 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004823 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004824 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4825 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004826 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4827 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4828 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4829 }
4830 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004831 }
4832
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004833 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4834 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004835 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00004836 Value *A, *B;
4837
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00004838 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
4839 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
4840 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4841 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
4842 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00004843 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00004844
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004845 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4846 default: break;
4847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4848 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004849 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004850 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4852 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004854 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4855 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4856 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4857 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4858
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004859 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004860
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4862 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004864 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4865 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4866 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4867 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00004868
4869 // (icmp slt (sub A B) 1) -> (icmp sle A B)
4870 if (CI->isOne() && match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4871 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, A, B);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004872 break;
4873
4874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4875 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4878 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4879 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4880 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004881
4882 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4883 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4884 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4885 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004886 break;
4887
4888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4889 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004891 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4892 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4893 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4894 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00004895
4896 // (icmp sgt (sub A B) -1) -> (icmp sge A B)
4897 if (CI->getValue().getSExtValue() == -1 &&
4898 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4899 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, A, B);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004900 break;
4901
4902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4903 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004905 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4906 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4907 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4908 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4909 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004910
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4912 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004914 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4915 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4916 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4917 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4918 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004919
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4921 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004923 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4924 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4925 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4926 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4927 break;
4928
4929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4930 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004932 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4933 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4934 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4935 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4936 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004937 }
4938
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004939 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4940 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004941 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4942 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004943 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004944 default: break;
4945 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4946 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4948 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4949 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4950 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4951 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4952 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004953 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004954
4955 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004956 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4957 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4958
4959 bool UnusedBit;
4960 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4961
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004962 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4963 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004964 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4965 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4966 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004967 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4968 return &I;
4969
4970 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4971 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004972 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004973 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4974 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004975 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4976 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004977 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004978 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4979 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004980 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004981 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4982 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004983 }
4984 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4985 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4986 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004987 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004989 break;
4990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004991 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004993 break;
4994 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004995 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004997 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004999 break;
5000 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005001 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005003 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005005 break;
5006 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005007 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005008 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005009 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005011 break;
5012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005013 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00005015 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005017 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005018 }
5019 }
5020
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005021 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005022 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005023 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005024 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005025 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5026 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005027 }
5028
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005029 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005030 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5031 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5032 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005033 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5034 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005035 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005036 bool isAllZeros = true;
5037 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5038 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5039 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5040 isAllZeros = false;
5041 break;
5042 }
5043 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005044 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005045 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5046 }
5047 break;
5048
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005049 case Instruction::PHI:
5050 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5051 return NV;
5052 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005053 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005054 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5055 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5056 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5057 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5058 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5059 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5060 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005061 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5062 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5063 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5064 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5065 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005066 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5067 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005068 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5069 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5070 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5071 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5072 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005073 }
5074 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005075
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005076 if (Op1)
5077 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
5078 break;
5079 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005080 case Instruction::Malloc:
5081 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5082 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5083 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5084 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5085 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5086 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
5087 }
5088 break;
5089 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005090 }
5091
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005092 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005093 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005094 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005095 return NI;
5096 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005097 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5098 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005099 return NI;
5100
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005101 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005102 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5103 // now.
5104 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5105 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5106 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005107 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5108 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005109 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005110
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005111 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5112 // so eliminate it as well.
5113 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5114 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005115
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005116 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005117 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005118 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005119 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005120 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005121 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005122 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005123 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005124 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005125 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005126 }
5127
5128 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005129 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005130 // This comes up when you have code like
5131 // int X = A < B;
5132 // if (X) ...
5133 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005134 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5135 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005136 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005137 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005138 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005139
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005140 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005141 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5142 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5143 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5144 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5145 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5146 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5147 }
5148
5149 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5150 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5151 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5152 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5153 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005154 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005155 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5156 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5157 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5158 }
5159
5160 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5161 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5162 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5163 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5164 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5165 }
5166 }
5167
5168 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5169 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005170 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5171 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005172 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5173 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005174 }
5175 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005176 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005177 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5178 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005179 }
5180 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005181 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005182 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5183 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005184 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005185
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005186 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5187 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5188 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5189 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5190 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5191
5192 if (A == C) {
5193 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5194 } else if (A == D) {
5195 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5196 } else if (B == C) {
5197 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5198 } else if (B == D) {
5199 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5200 }
5201
5202 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5203 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5204 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5205 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5206 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5207 return &I;
5208 }
5209 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005210 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005211 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005212}
5213
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005214
5215/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5216/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5217Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5218 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5219 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5220 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5221
5222 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5223 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5224 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5225 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5226 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5227 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5228 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5229 // if it finds it.
5230 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5231 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5232 return 0;
5233 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005234 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005235
5236 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5237 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5238 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5239 // instead of computing a divide.
5240 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5241
5242 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5243 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5244 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5245 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5246 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5247
5248 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005249 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005250
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005251 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5252 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5253 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5254 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5255 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5256 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5257 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5258 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5259 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5260
5261
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005262 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005263 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005264 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005265 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5266 if (!HiOverflow)
5267 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005268 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5269 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005270 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005271 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5272 HiBound = DivRHS;
5273 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005274 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5275 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5276 if (!HiOverflow)
5277 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005278 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005279 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005280 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5281 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005282 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005283 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005284 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005285 }
5286 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5287 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005288 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005289 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5290 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005291 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5292 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5293 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5294 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005295 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005296 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5297 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005298 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005299 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005300 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5301 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005302 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005303 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005304 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005305 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5306 }
5307
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005308 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5309 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005310 }
5311
5312 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005313 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005314 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5316 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5317 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5318 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005319 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005320 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5321 else if (LoOverflow)
5322 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5323 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5324 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005325 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5327 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5329 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005330 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005331 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5332 else if (LoOverflow)
5333 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5334 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5335 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005336 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005337 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5338 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005339 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5341 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005343 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5345 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005346 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005348 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5350 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005351 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5352 else
5353 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5354 }
5355}
5356
5357
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005358/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5359///
5360Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5361 Instruction *LHSI,
5362 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5363 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5364
5365 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005366 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005367 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5368 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5369 // fold the xor.
5370 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5371 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5372 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5373
5374 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5375 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5376 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5377 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5378 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5379 return &ICI;
5380 }
5381
5382 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5383 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5384
5385 // If so, the new one isn't.
5386 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5387
5388 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5389 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5390 else
5391 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5392 }
5393 }
5394 break;
5395 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5396 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5397 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5398 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5399
5400 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5401 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5402 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5403 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5404 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5405 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5406 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5407 // bit would not work.
5408 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5409 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5410 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5411 uint32_t BitWidth =
5412 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5413 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5414 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5415 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5416 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5417 Instruction *NewAnd =
5418 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5419 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5420 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5421 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5422 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5423 }
5424 }
5425
5426 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5427 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5428 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5429 // access.
5430 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5431 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5432 Shift = 0;
5433
5434 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5435 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5436 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5437 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5438
5439 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5440 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5441 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5442 if (ShAmt) {
5443 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5444 if (!CanFold) {
5445 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5446 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5447 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5448 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5449
5450 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5451 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5452 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5453 CanFold = true;
5454 }
5455
5456 if (CanFold) {
5457 Constant *NewCst;
5458 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5459 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5460 else
5461 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5462
5463 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5464 // compared.
5465 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5466 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5467 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5468 // result is always true or false now.
5469 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5471 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5472 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5473 } else {
5474 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5475 Constant *NewAndCST;
5476 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5477 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5478 else
5479 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5480 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5481 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5482 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5483 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5484 return &ICI;
5485 }
5486 }
5487 }
5488
5489 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5490 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5491 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5492 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5493 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5494 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5495 // Compute C << Y.
5496 Value *NS;
5497 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5498 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5499 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5500 } else {
5501 // Insert a logical shift.
5502 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5503 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5504 }
5505 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5506
5507 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5508 Instruction *NewAnd =
5509 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5510 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5511
5512 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5513 return &ICI;
5514 }
5515 }
5516 break;
5517
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005518 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5519 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5520 if (!ShAmt) break;
5521
5522 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5523
5524 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5525 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5526 // simplified.
5527 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5528 break;
5529
5530 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5531 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5532 // comparison cannot succeed.
5533 Constant *Comp =
5534 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5535 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5536 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5537 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5539 }
5540
5541 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5542 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5543 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5544 Constant *Mask =
5545 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005546
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005547 Instruction *AndI =
5548 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5549 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5550 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5551 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5552 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005553 }
5554 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005555
5556 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5557 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5558 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5559 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5560 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5561 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5562 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5563 Instruction *AndI =
5564 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5565 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5566 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5567
5568 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5569 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5570 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005571 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005572 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005573
5574 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005575 case Instruction::AShr: {
5576 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5577 if (!ShAmt) break;
5578
5579 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5580 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5581 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5582 // simplified.
5583 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5584 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5585 break;
5586 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5587
5588 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5589 // comparison cannot succeed.
5590 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5591 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5592 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5593 else
5594 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5595
5596 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5597 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5598 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5599 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5600 }
5601
5602 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5603 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5604 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5605 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005606
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005607 Instruction *AndI =
5608 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5609 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5610 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5611 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5612 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005613 }
5614 }
5615 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005616 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005617
5618 case Instruction::SDiv:
5619 case Instruction::UDiv:
5620 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5621 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5622 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5623 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5624 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5625 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005626 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5627 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5628 DivRHS))
5629 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005630 break;
5631 }
5632
5633 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5634 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5635 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5636
5637 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5638 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5639 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5640 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5641 case Instruction::SRem:
5642 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5643 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5644 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5645 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5646 Instruction *NewRem =
5647 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5648 BO->getName());
5649 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5650 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5651 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5652 }
5653 }
5654 break;
5655 case Instruction::Add:
5656 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5657 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5658 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5659 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5660 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5661 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5662 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5663 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5664 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5665
5666 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5667 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5668 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5669 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5670 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5671 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5672 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5673 Neg->takeName(BO);
5674 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5675 }
5676 }
5677 break;
5678 case Instruction::Xor:
5679 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5680 // the explicit xor.
5681 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5682 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5683 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5684
5685 // FALLTHROUGH
5686 case Instruction::Sub:
5687 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5688 if (RHSV == 0)
5689 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5690 BO->getOperand(1));
5691 break;
5692
5693 case Instruction::Or:
5694 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5695 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5696 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5697 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5698 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5700 isICMP_NE));
5701 }
5702 break;
5703
5704 case Instruction::And:
5705 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5706 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5707 // comparison can never succeed!
5708 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5710 isICMP_NE));
5711
5712 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5713 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5714 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5715 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5716 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5717
5718 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5719 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5720 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5721 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5722 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5723 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5724 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5725 }
5726
5727 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5728 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5729 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5730 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5731 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5732 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5733 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5734 }
5735 }
5736 default: break;
5737 }
5738 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5739 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5740 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5741 AddToWorkList(II);
5742 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5743 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5744 return &ICI;
5745 }
5746 }
5747 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005748 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5749 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005750 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5751 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5752 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5753 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5754 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5755 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5756 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5757 // smaller constant values.
5758 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5759 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5760 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5761 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5762 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5763 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5764 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5765 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5766 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5767 }
5768 }
5769 }
5770 }
5771 return 0;
5772}
5773
5774/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5775/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5776///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005777Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5778 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005779 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5780 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005781 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005782 Value *RHSCIOp;
5783
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005784 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5785 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5786 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5787 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5788 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5789 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5790 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005791 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005792 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5793 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5794 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5795 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5796 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5797 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5798 }
5799
5800 if (RHSOp)
5801 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5802 }
5803
5804 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5805 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005806 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5807 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005808 return 0;
5809
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005810 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5811 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005812
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005813 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005814 // Not an extension from the same type?
5815 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005816 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5817 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005818
5819 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5820 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5821 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5822 return 0;
5823
5824 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5825 // then we can't handle this.
5826 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5827 return 0;
5828
5829 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5830 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005831 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005832
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005833 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5834 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5835 if (!CI)
5836 return 0;
5837
5838 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5839 // reextended to DestTy.
5840 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5841 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5842
5843 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5844 if (Res2 == CI) {
5845 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5846 // For example, we might have:
5847 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5848 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5849 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5850 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5851 // because %A may have negative value.
5852 //
5853 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5854 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005855 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005856 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5857 else
5858 return 0;
5859 }
5860
5861 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5862 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5863
5864 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5865 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5866 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005868 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005870
5871 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5872 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5873 Value *Result;
5874 if (isSignedCmp) {
5875 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005876 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005877 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005878 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005879 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005880 } else {
5881 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5882 if (isSignedExt) {
5883 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5884 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005885 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005886 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5887 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5888 } else {
5889 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005890 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005891 }
5892 }
5893
5894 // Finally, return the value computed.
5895 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5896 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5898 } else {
5899 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5900 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5901 "ICmp should be folded!");
5902 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5903 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5904 else
5905 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5906 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005907}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005908
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005909Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5910 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5911}
5912
5913Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5914 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5915}
5916
5917Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00005918 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
5919 return R;
5920
5921 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
5922
5923 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5924 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
5925 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
5926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5927
5928 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
5929 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5930 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
5931 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
5932
5933 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005934}
5935
5936Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5937 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005938 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005939
5940 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5941 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005942 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005943 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005945
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005946 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5947 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005949 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5951 }
5952 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005953 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5955 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005957 }
5958
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005959 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5960 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5961 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005962 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005963 return R;
5964
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005965 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005966 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5967 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005968 return 0;
5969}
5970
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005971Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005972 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005973 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005974
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005975 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5976 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005977 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5978 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5979 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005980 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5981 return &I;
5982
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005983 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5984 // of a signed value.
5985 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005986 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005987 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5989 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005990 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005991 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005992 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005993 }
5994
5995 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5996 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5997 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5998 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5999 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
6000 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6001
6002 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6003 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6004 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6005 return R;
6006 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6007 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6008 return NV;
6009
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006010 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6011 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6012 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6013 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6014 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6015 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6016 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6017 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6018 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6019 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6020 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6021 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
6022 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
6023 I.getName());
6024 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6025
6026 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6027 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6028 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6029 // other xforms later if dead.
6030 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6031 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6032 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6033
6034 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6035 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6036 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6037 // mask as appropriate.
6038 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6039 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6040 else {
6041 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6042 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6043 }
6044
6045 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
6046 TI->getName());
6047 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6048
6049 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6050 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6051 }
6052 }
6053
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006054 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006055 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6056 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6057 Value *V1, *V2;
6058 ConstantInt *CC;
6059 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006060 default: break;
6061 case Instruction::Add:
6062 case Instruction::And:
6063 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006064 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006065 // These operators commute.
6066 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006067 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6068 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006069 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006070 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006071 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006072 Op0BO->getName());
6073 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006074 Instruction *X =
6075 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
6076 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006077 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006078 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006079 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
6080 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006081 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006082
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006083 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006084 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006085 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006086 match(Op0BOOp1,
6087 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006088 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6089 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006090 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006091 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6092 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006093 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6094 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006095 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006096 V1->getName()+".mask");
6097 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6098
6099 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
6100 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006101 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006102
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006103 // FALL THROUGH.
6104 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006105 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006106 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6107 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006108 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006109 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006110 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6111 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006112 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006113 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006114 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006115 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006116 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006117 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006118 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
6119 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006120 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006121
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006122 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006123 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6124 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6125 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006126 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006127 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6128 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006129 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006130 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6131 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006132 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6133 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006134 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006135 V1->getName()+".mask");
6136 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6137
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006138 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006139 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006140
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006141 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006142 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006143 }
6144
6145
6146 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6147 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6148 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6149 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6150 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6151
6152 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006153 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006154 case Instruction::Add:
6155 isValid = isLeftShift;
6156 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006157 case Instruction::Or:
6158 case Instruction::Xor:
6159 highBitSet = false;
6160 break;
6161 case Instruction::And:
6162 highBitSet = true;
6163 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006164 }
6165
6166 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6167 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6168 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6169 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6170 // operation.
6171 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006172 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006173 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006174
6175 if (isValid) {
6176 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6177
6178 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006179 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006180 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006181 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006182
6183 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6184 NewRHS);
6185 }
6186 }
6187 }
6188 }
6189
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006190 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006191 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6192 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6193 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006194
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006195 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006196 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006197 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6198 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006199 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6200 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6201 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006202
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006203 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006204 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6205 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006206
6207 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6208
6209 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006210 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006211 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6212 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6213 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6214 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6215 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6216 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6217 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6218 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6219 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6220 Instruction *Shift =
6221 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6222 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6223
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006224 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006225 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006226 }
6227
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006228 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6229 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6230 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6231 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6232 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006233 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006234 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006235 }
6236 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6237 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006238 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006239 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006240 }
6241 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6242 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6243 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6244 // generators.
6245 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6246 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006247 case 1 :
6248 case 8 :
6249 case 16 :
6250 case 32 :
6251 case 64 :
6252 case 128:
6253 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6254 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006255 default: break;
6256 }
6257 if (SExtType) {
6258 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6259 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6260 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6261 }
6262 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6263 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006264 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006265
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006266 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006267 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6268 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6269 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006270 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006271 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006272 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6273
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006274 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6275 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006276 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006277
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006278 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006279 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6280 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6281 Instruction *Shift =
6282 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6283 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006284
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006285 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006286 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006287 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006288
6289 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6290 } else {
6291 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006292 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006293
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006294 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006295 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6296 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6297 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6298 Instruction *Shift =
6299 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6300 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6301 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6302
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006303 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006304 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006305 }
6306
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006307 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006308 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6309 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6310 Instruction *Shift =
6311 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6312 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6313
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006314 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006315 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006316 }
6317
6318 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006319 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006320 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006321 return 0;
6322}
6323
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006324
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006325/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6326/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6327/// X*Scale+Offset.
6328///
6329static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006330 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006331 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006332 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006333 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006334 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006335 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006336 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6337 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6338 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6339 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6340 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6341 Offset = 0;
6342 return I->getOperand(0);
6343 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6344 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6345 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6346 Offset = 0;
6347 return I->getOperand(0);
6348 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6349 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6350 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6351 unsigned SubScale;
6352 Value *SubVal =
6353 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6354 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6355 Scale = SubScale;
6356 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006357 }
6358 }
6359 }
6360
6361 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6362 Scale = 1;
6363 Offset = 0;
6364 return Val;
6365}
6366
6367
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006368/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6369/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006370Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006371 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006372 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006373
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006374 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6375 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006376
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006377 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6378 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6379 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6380 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6381 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6382
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006383 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006384 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006385 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006386 }
6387 }
6388
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006389 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6390 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6391 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6392 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006393
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006394 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6395 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006396 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6397
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006398 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6399 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6400 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6401 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6402
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006403 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6404 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006405 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006406
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006407 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6408 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006409 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6410 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006411 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6412 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6413
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006414 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6415 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006416 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6417 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006418
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006419 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6420 Value *Amt = 0;
6421 if (Scale == 1) {
6422 Amt = NumElements;
6423 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006424 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006425 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6426 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006427 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006428 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006429 else if (Scale != 1) {
6430 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6431 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006432 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006433 }
6434
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006435 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6436 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006437 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6438 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6439 }
6440
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006441 AllocationInst *New;
6442 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006443 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006444 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006445 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006446 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006447 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006448
6449 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6450 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6451 // die soon.
6452 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6453 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006454 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6455 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6456 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006457 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6458 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6459 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6461}
6462
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006463/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006464/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6465/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6466/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6467/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6468///
6469/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6470/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6471static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006472 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006473 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6474 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6475 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006476
6477 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006478 if (!I) return false;
6479
6480 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006481
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006482 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6483 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6484 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6485 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6486 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6487 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6488 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6489 // casts first.
6490 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
6491 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6492 return true;
6493 }
6494 }
6495
6496 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6497 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6498 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6499
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006500 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006501 case Instruction::Add:
6502 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006503 case Instruction::And:
6504 case Instruction::Or:
6505 case Instruction::Xor:
6506 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006507 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6508 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6509 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6510 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006511
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006512 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006513 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6514 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6515 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006516 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6517 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6518 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006519 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6520 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006521 }
6522 break;
6523 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006524 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6525 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6526 // already zeros.
6527 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006528 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6529 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6530 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006531 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006532 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6533 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006534 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6535 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006536 }
6537 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006538 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006539 case Instruction::ZExt:
6540 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006541 case Instruction::Trunc:
6542 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006543 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6544 // of casts in the input.
6545 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006546 return true;
Chris Lattner50d9d772007-09-10 23:46:29 +00006547
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006548 break;
6549 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006550 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6551 break;
6552 }
6553
6554 return false;
6555}
6556
6557/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6558/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6559/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006560Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006561 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006562 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006563 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006564
6565 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6566 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006567 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006568 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006569 case Instruction::Add:
6570 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006571 case Instruction::And:
6572 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006573 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006574 case Instruction::AShr:
6575 case Instruction::LShr:
6576 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006577 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006578 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6579 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6580 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006581 break;
6582 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006583 case Instruction::Trunc:
6584 case Instruction::ZExt:
6585 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006586 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006587 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
6588 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006589 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6590 return I->getOperand(0);
6591
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006592 // Otherwise, must be the same type of case, so just reinsert a new one.
6593 Res = CastInst::create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
6594 Ty, I->getName());
6595 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006596 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006597 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6598 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6599 break;
6600 }
6601
6602 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6603}
6604
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006605/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6606Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006607 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6608
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006609 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006610 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006611 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006612 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6613 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6614 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6615 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6616 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006617 }
6618 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006619
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006620 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006621 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6622 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6623 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006624
6625 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006626 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6627 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6628 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006629
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006630 return 0;
6631}
6632
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006633/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6634Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6635 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6636
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006637 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006638 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6639 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006640 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6641 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6642 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6643 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006644 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006645 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6646 return &CI;
6647 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006648
6649 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6650 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6651 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6652 // non-type-safe code.
6653 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6654 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6655 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6656 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6657 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6658
6659 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6660 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6661 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6662 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6663 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6664 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6665
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006666 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6667 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6668 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006669 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006670 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006671 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006672 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6673 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006674
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006675 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6676 if (Offset < 0) {
6677 --FirstIdx;
6678 Offset += TySize;
6679 assert(Offset >= 0);
6680 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006681 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006682 }
6683
6684 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006685
6686 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6687 while (Offset) {
6688 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6689 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006690 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6691 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6692 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006693
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006694 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6695 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6696 } else {
6697 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6698 Offset = 0;
6699 OrigBase = 0;
6700 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006701 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6702 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006703 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006704 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6705 Offset %= EltSize;
6706 } else {
6707 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6708 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006709 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6710 } else {
6711 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6712 Offset = 0;
6713 OrigBase = 0;
6714 }
6715 }
6716 if (OrigBase) {
6717 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6718 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6719 // two.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00006720 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase,
6721 NewIndices.begin(),
6722 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006723 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6724 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6725
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006726 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6727 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6728 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6729 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6730 }
6731 }
6732 }
6733 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006734 }
6735
6736 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6737}
6738
6739
6740
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006741/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6742/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006743/// cases.
6744/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6745Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6746 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6747 return Result;
6748
6749 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6750 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6751 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006752 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6753 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006754
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006755 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6756 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006757 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6758 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006759 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6760 return &CI;
6761
6762 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6763 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006764 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6765 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006766 return 0;
6767
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006768 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006769 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006770 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6771 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006772 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006773 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006774 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
6775 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
6776 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
6777 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006778 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006779 bool DoXForm;
6780 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6781 default:
6782 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6783 // get here because of the check above.
6784 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6785 case Instruction::Trunc:
6786 DoXForm = true;
6787 break;
6788 case Instruction::ZExt:
6789 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6790 break;
6791 case Instruction::SExt:
6792 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6793 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006794 }
6795
6796 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006797 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6798 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006799 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6800 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6801 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6802 case Instruction::Trunc:
6803 case Instruction::BitCast:
6804 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6805 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6806 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6807 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6808 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006809 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6810 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006811 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6812 }
6813 case Instruction::SExt:
6814 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6815 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006816 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6817 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006818 }
6819 }
6820 }
6821
6822 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6823 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6824
6825 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6826 case Instruction::Add:
6827 case Instruction::Mul:
6828 case Instruction::And:
6829 case Instruction::Or:
6830 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006831 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006832 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6833 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6834 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6835 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6836 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006837 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6838 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006839 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006840 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6841 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6842 return BinaryOperator::create(
6843 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006844 }
6845 }
6846
6847 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6848 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6849 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006850 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006851 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006852 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006853 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6854 }
6855 break;
6856 case Instruction::SDiv:
6857 case Instruction::UDiv:
6858 case Instruction::SRem:
6859 case Instruction::URem:
6860 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6861 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6862 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6863 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6864 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006865 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6866 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006867 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6868 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6869 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6870 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006871 return BinaryOperator::create(
6872 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6873 }
6874 }
6875 break;
6876
6877 case Instruction::Shl:
6878 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6879 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6880 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6881 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6882 // in the value.
6883 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6884 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006885 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6886 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6887 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006888 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006889 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006890 }
6891 break;
6892 case Instruction::AShr:
6893 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6894 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6895 // simplifications.
6896 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6897 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006898 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006899 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6900 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006901 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006902 }
6903 }
6904 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006905 }
6906 return 0;
6907}
6908
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006909Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006910 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6911 return Result;
6912
6913 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6914 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006915 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6916 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006917
6918 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6919 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6920 default: break;
6921 case Instruction::LShr:
6922 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6923 // are already zeros.
6924 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006925 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006926
6927 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006928 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006929 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6930 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006931 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6933
6934 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6935 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006936 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6937 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6938 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006939 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006940 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006941 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6942
6943 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6944 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6945 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006946 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006947 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6948
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006949 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006950 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006951 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006952 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6953 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6954 "tmp"), CI);
6955 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006956 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006957 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006958 }
6959 break;
6960 }
6961 }
6962
6963 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006964}
6965
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006966Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006967 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6968 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6969 return Result;
6970
6971 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6972
6973 // If this is a cast of a cast
6974 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006975 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6976 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6977 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6978 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6979 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6980 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006981 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6982 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6983 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006984 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6985 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6986 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006987 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006988 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006989 Instruction *And =
6990 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6991 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6992 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6993 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6994 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006995 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006996 }
6997 return And;
6998 }
6999 }
7000 }
7001
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007002 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7003 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7004 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7005 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7006 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007007 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007008
7009 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7010 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7011 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7012 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7013 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7014 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7015 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
7016 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007017 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007018 CI);
7019 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
7020 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
7021 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7022
7023 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7024 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
7025 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007026 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007027 CI);
7028 }
7029
7030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7031 }
7032
7033
7034
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007035 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7036 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7037 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7038 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7039 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7040 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7041 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7042 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007043 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7044 // This only works for EQ and NE
7045 ICI->isEquality()) {
7046 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7047 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7048 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7049 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7050 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7051
7052 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7053 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7054 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7055 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7056 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7057 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7058 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7059 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7061 }
7062
7063 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7064 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7065 if (ShiftAmt) {
7066 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7067 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
7068 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
7069 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
7070 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7071 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7072 }
7073
7074 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7075 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
7076 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
7077 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7078 }
7079
7080 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7081 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7082 else
7083 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
7084 }
7085 }
7086 }
7087 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007088 return 0;
7089}
7090
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007091Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007092 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7093 return I;
7094
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007095 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7096
7097 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7098 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7099 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7100 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7101 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7102 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7103 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7104 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7105
7106 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7107 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7108 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7109 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7110 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7111 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7112 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
7113 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007114 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007115 CI);
7116 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
7117 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
7118 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7119
7120 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
7121 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
7122 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7123
7124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7125 }
7126 }
7127 }
7128
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007129 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007130}
7131
7132Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
7133 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7134}
7135
7136Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7137 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7138}
7139
7140Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007141 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007142}
7143
7144Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007145 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007146}
7147
7148Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7149 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7150}
7151
7152Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7153 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7154}
7155
7156Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007157 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007158}
7159
7160Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7161 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7162}
7163
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007164Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007165 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7166 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7167 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7168 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7169 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7170
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007171 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007172 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7173 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007174 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7175 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7176 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007177 } else {
7178 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7179 return Result;
7180 }
7181
7182
7183 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7184 // be replaced by the operand.
7185 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7187
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007188 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007189 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7190 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7191 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7192
7193 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7194 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7195 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7196 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7197 return V;
7198
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007199 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7200 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007201 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7202 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7203 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7204 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7205 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7206 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7207 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7208 ++NumZeros;
7209 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007210
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007211 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7212 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7213 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Chuck Rose IIIc331d302007-09-05 20:36:41 +00007214 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7215 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007216 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007217 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007218
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007219 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7220 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7221 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7222 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007223 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7224 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007225 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7226 CastInst *Tmp;
7227 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7228 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7229 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7230 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7231 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7232 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7233 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007234 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7235 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7236 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7237 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007238 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7239 // know the vector types match #elts.
7240 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007241 }
7242 }
7243 }
7244 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007245 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007246}
7247
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007248/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7249/// %C = or %A, %B
7250/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7251/// into:
7252/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7253/// %D = or %A, %C
7254///
7255/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7256/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7257/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7258///
7259static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7260 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7261 case Instruction::Add:
7262 case Instruction::Mul:
7263 case Instruction::And:
7264 case Instruction::Or:
7265 case Instruction::Xor:
7266 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7267 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7268 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007269 case Instruction::LShr:
7270 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007271 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007272 default:
7273 return 0; // Cannot fold
7274 }
7275}
7276
7277/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7278/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7279static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7280 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7281 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7282 case Instruction::Add:
7283 case Instruction::Sub:
7284 case Instruction::Or:
7285 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007286 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007287 case Instruction::LShr:
7288 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007289 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007290 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007291 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007292 case Instruction::Mul:
7293 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7294 }
7295}
7296
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007297/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7298/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7299Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7300 Instruction *FI) {
7301 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7302 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7303 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007304 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007305 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7306 return 0;
7307 } else {
7308 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7309 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007310
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007311 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7312 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7313 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7314 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007315 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7316 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007317 }
7318
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007319 // Only handle binary operators here.
7320 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007321 return 0;
7322
7323 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7324 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7325 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7326 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7327 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7328 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7329 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7330 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7331 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7332 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7333 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7334 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7335 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7336 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7337 return 0;
7338 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7339 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7340 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7341 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7342 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7343 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7344 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7345 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7346 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7347 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7348 } else {
7349 return 0;
7350 }
7351
7352 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7353 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7354 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7355 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7356
7357 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7358 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7359 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7360 else
7361 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007362 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007363 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7364 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007365}
7366
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007367Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007368 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7369 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7370 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7371
7372 // select true, X, Y -> X
7373 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007374 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007376
7377 // select C, X, X -> X
7378 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7380
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007381 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7383 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7385 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7386 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7387 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7388 else
7389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7390 }
7391
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007392 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007393 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007394 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007395 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007396 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007397 } else {
7398 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7399 Value *NotCond =
7400 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7401 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007402 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007403 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007404 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007405 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007406 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007407 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007408 } else {
7409 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7410 Value *NotCond =
7411 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7412 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007413 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007414 }
7415 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00007416
7417 // select a, b, a -> a&b
7418 // select a, a, b -> a|b
7419 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
7420 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
7421 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
7422 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007423 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007424
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007425 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7426 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7427 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007428 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007429 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007430 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007431 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007432 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007433 Value *NotCond =
7434 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007435 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007436 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007437 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007438
7439 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007440
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007441 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007442
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007443 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007444 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007445 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007446 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007447 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007448 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007449 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007450 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007451 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7452 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7453 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007454 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7455
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007456 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7457 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7458 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007459 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7460 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007461 if (SRASize < SISize)
7462 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7463 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7464 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7465 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007466 }
7467 }
7468
7469
7470 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007471 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007472 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7473 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007474 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007475 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007476 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7477 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7478 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007479 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7480 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7481 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007482 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7483 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007484 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7485 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007486 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007487 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007488 Value *V = ICA;
7489 if (ShouldNotVal)
7490 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7491 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7492 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7493 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007494 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007495 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007496
7497 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007498 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7499 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007500 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007501 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
7502 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
7503 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
7504 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
7505 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
7506 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
7507 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
7508 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
7509 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007511 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007512 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007513 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7515 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7516
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007517 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007518 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00007519 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
7520 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
7521 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
7522 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
7523 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
7524 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
7525 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
7526 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
7527 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
7528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7529 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007530 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007531 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7533 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7534 }
7535 }
7536
7537 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7538 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7539 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7540 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7541 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7543 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7544 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7546 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7547
7548 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7549 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7550 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7551 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7552 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7553 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007555 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7556 }
7557 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007558
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007559 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7560 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7561 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007562 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7563
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007564 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7565 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7566 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7567 return IV;
7568
7569 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7570 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007571 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7572 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7573 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7574 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7575 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7576 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7577 }
7578
7579 if (AddOp) {
7580 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7581 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7582 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7583 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7584 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7585 }
7586
7587 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007588 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7589 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7590 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7591 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7592 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7593 } else {
7594 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7595 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007596 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007597
7598 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7599 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7600 if (AddOp != TI)
7601 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7602 Instruction *NewSel =
7603 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7604
7605 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7606 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007607 }
7608 }
7609 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007610
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007611 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007612 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007613 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7614 // transformation we are doing here.
7615 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7616 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7617 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7618 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7619 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7620 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7621 OpToFold = 1;
7622 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7623 OpToFold = 2;
7624 }
7625
7626 if (OpToFold) {
7627 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007628 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007629 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007630 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007631 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007632 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7633 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007634 else {
7635 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7636 }
7637 }
7638 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007639
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007640 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7641 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7642 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7643 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7644 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7645 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7646 OpToFold = 1;
7647 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7648 OpToFold = 2;
7649 }
7650
7651 if (OpToFold) {
7652 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007653 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007654 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007655 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007656 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007657 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7658 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007659 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007660 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007661 }
7662 }
7663 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007664
7665 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7666 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7667 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7668 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7669 return &SI;
7670 }
7671
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007672 return 0;
7673}
7674
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007675/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
7676/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
7677/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
7678/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
7679static unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD,
7680 unsigned PrefAlign = 0) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007681 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7682 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
Andrew Lenharthb410df92007-11-08 18:45:15 +00007683 if (Align == 0 && TD && GV->getType()->getElementType()->isSized())
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007684 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007685
7686 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
7687 // of the global.
7688 if (PrefAlign > Align && GV->hasInitializer()) {
7689 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7690 Align = PrefAlign;
7691 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007692 return Align;
7693 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7694 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7695 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7696 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007697 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007698 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7699 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007700 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007701 Align =
7702 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007703 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007704 Align =
7705 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007706 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007707 }
7708 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007709
7710 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
7711 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
7712 if (PrefAlign > Align && isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
7713 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7714 Align = PrefAlign;
7715 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007716 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007717 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007718 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007719 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007720 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(cast<User>(V)->getOperand(0),
7721 TD, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007722 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007723 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7724 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7725 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7726 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7727 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7728 AllZeroOperands = false;
7729 break;
7730 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007731
7732 if (AllZeroOperands) {
7733 // Treat this like a bitcast.
7734 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD, PrefAlign);
7735 }
7736
7737 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0),TD);
7738 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7739
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007740 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7741 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7742 // least as much as its type requires.
7743 if (!TD) return 0;
7744
7745 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007746 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007747 unsigned Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType());
7748 if (Align <= BaseAlignment) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007749 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007750 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007751 Align = std::min(Align, (unsigned)
7752 TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType()));
7753 return Align;
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007754 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007755 return 0;
7756 }
7757 return 0;
7758}
7759
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007760
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007761/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7762/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7763/// the heavy lifting.
7764///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007765Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007766 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7767 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7768
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007769 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7770 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007771 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007772 bool Changed = false;
7773
7774 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7775 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7776 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7777
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007778 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007779 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007780 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7781 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7782 // alignment is sufficient.
7783 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007784 }
7785
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007786 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7787 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7788 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007789 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007790 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7791 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7792 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007793 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007794 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007795 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007796 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7797 else
7798 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007799 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007800 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7801 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7802 Changed = true;
7803 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007804 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007805
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007806 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7807 // set, update the alignment.
7808 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007809 unsigned Alignment1 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7810 unsigned Alignment2 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007811 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007812 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007813 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007814 Changed = true;
7815 }
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007816
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007817 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
7818 // load/store.
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007819 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CI.getOperand(3));
Devang Patel7b9e1d22007-10-12 20:10:21 +00007820 if (MemOpLength) {
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007821 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
7822 unsigned Align = cast<ConstantInt>(CI.getOperand(4))->getZExtValue();
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007823 PointerType *NewPtrTy = NULL;
Devang Patel7b9e1d22007-10-12 20:10:21 +00007824 // Destination pointer type is always i8 *
Devang Patelb9e98132007-10-15 15:31:35 +00007825 // If Size is 8 then use Int64Ty
7826 // If Size is 4 then use Int32Ty
7827 // If Size is 2 then use Int16Ty
7828 // If Size is 1 then use Int8Ty
7829 if (Size && Size <=8 && !(Size&(Size-1)))
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00007830 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Devang Patelb9e98132007-10-15 15:31:35 +00007831
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007832 if (NewPtrTy) {
Chris Lattnerbde90f02007-11-06 01:15:27 +00007833 Value *Src = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI.getOperand(2),
7834 NewPtrTy, CI);
7835 Value *Dest = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI.getOperand(1),
7836 NewPtrTy, CI);
Devang Patelafc407e2007-10-17 07:24:40 +00007837 Value *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, Align, &CI);
Devang Patelf9193de2007-10-11 17:21:57 +00007838 Value *NS = new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, Align, &CI);
7839 CI.replaceAllUsesWith(NS);
7840 Changed = true;
7841 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7842 }
7843 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007844 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007845 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007846 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007847 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007848 Changed = true;
7849 }
7850 }
7851
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007852 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007853 } else {
7854 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7855 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007856 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7857 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007858 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7859 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7860 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7861 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7862 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007863 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00007864 Value *Ptr =
7865 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7866 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007867 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7868 }
7869 break;
7870 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7871 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7872 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007873 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00007874 const Type *OpPtrTy =
7875 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007876 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7877 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007878 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7879 }
7880 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007881 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7882 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7883 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7884 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7885 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007886 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00007887 const Type *OpPtrTy =
7888 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007889 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7890 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007891 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7892 }
7893 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007894
7895 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7896 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7897 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7898 uint64_t UndefElts;
7899 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7900 UndefElts)) {
7901 II->setOperand(1, V);
7902 return II;
7903 }
7904 break;
7905 }
7906
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007907 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7908 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007909 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007910 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7911
7912 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7913 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7914 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7915 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7916 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7917 AllEltsOk = false;
7918 break;
7919 }
7920 }
7921
7922 if (AllEltsOk) {
7923 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007924 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7925 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7926 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7927 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007928 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7929
7930 // Only extract each element once.
7931 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7932 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7933
7934 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7935 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7936 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007937 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007938 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7939
7940 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7941 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007942 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007943 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7944 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7945 }
7946
7947 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007948 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007949 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7950 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007951 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007952 }
7953 }
7954 break;
7955
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007956 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7957 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7958 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7959 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7960 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7961 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7962 if (&*++BI == II)
7963 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7964 }
7965 }
7966
7967 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7968 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7969 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7970 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7971 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7972 bool CannotRemove = false;
7973 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7974 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7975 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7976 CannotRemove = true;
7977 break;
7978 }
7979 }
7980 if (!CannotRemove)
7981 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7982 }
7983 break;
7984 }
7985 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007986 }
7987
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007988 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007989}
7990
7991// InvokeInst simplification
7992//
7993Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007994 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007995}
7996
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007997// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7998//
7999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008000 bool Changed = false;
8001
8002 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8003 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008004 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8005
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008006 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008007
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008008 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8009 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8010 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8011 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8012 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008013 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008014 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8015 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008016 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8017 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8018 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8019 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8020 return 0;
8021 }
8022
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008023 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8024 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8025 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8026 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008027 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008028 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008029 CS.getInstruction());
8030
8031 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8032 CS.getInstruction()->
8033 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8034
8035 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8036 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
8037 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008038 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008039 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008040 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8041 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008042
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008043 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8044 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8045 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8046 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8047
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008048 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8049 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8050 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
8051 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8052 // the call.
8053 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
8054 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
8055 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
8056 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
8057 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
8058 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008059 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008060 *I = Op;
8061 Changed = true;
8062 }
8063 }
8064 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008065
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008066 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008067 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008068 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008069 Changed = true;
8070 }
8071
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008072 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008073}
8074
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008075// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8076// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8077//
8078bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8079 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8080 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008081 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8082 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008083 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008084 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008085 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
8086
8087 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8088 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8089 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8090 //
8091 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8092 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
8093
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008094 const ParamAttrsList* CallerPAL = 0;
8095 if (CallInst *CallerCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(Caller))
8096 CallerPAL = CallerCI->getParamAttrs();
8097 else if (InvokeInst *CallerII = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8098 CallerPAL = CallerII->getParamAttrs();
8099
Duncan Sands827cde12007-11-25 14:10:56 +00008100 // If the parameter attributes are not compatible, don't do the xform. We
8101 // don't want to lose an sret attribute or something.
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008102 if (!ParamAttrsList::areCompatible(CallerPAL, Callee->getParamAttrs()))
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00008103 return false;
Duncan Sands827cde12007-11-25 14:10:56 +00008104
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008105 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
8106 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008107 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00008108 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
8109 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
8110 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008111 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008112
8113 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8114 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8115 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8116 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8117 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8118 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8119 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8120 UI != E; ++UI)
8121 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8122 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008123 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008124 return false;
8125 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008126
8127 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8128 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008129
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008130 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8131 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8132 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008133 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008134 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008135 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008136 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008137 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00008138 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008139 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008140 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
8141 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00008142 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008143 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008144
8145 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
8146 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
8147 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
8148 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
8149 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
8150 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
8151 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8152 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8153 return false;
8154 }
8155 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
8156 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8157 return false;
8158 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
8159 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8160 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8161 return false;
8162 }
8163 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
8164 return false;
8165 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
8166 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8167 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
8168 return false;
8169 }
8170 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8171 return false;
8172 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
8173 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8174 return false;
8175 } else {
8176 return false;
8177 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008178 }
8179
8180 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008181 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008182 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
8183
8184 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
8185 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
8186 std::vector<Value*> Args;
8187 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
8188
8189 AI = CS.arg_begin();
8190 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8191 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
8192 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
8193 Args.push_back(*AI);
8194 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008195 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008196 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008197 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008198 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008199 }
8200 }
8201
8202 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8203 // now...
8204 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8205 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8206
8207 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
8208 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
8209 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008210 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8211 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008212 } else {
8213 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8214 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8215 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8216 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8217 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008218 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8219 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008220 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008221 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8222 Args.push_back(Cast);
8223 } else {
8224 Args.push_back(*AI);
8225 }
8226 }
8227 }
8228
8229 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008230 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008231
8232 Instruction *NC;
8233 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008234 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
David Greenef1355a52007-08-27 19:04:21 +00008235 Args.begin(), Args.end(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00008236 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008237 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(CallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008238 } else {
Chris Lattner684b22d2007-08-02 16:53:43 +00008239 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
8240 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008241 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
8242 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00008243 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008244 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
8245 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(CallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008246 }
8247
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008248 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008249 Value *NV = NC;
8250 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8251 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008252 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008253 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8254 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008255 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008256
8257 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8258 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8259 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8260 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8261 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8262 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8263 } else {
8264 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8265 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8266 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008267 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008268 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008269 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008270 }
8271 }
8272
8273 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8274 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008275 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008276 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008277 return true;
8278}
8279
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008280// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
8281// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
8282//
8283Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
8284 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
8285 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8286 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8287
8288 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
8289 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
8290
8291 Function *NestF =
8292 cast<Function>(IntrinsicInst::StripPointerCasts(Tramp->getOperand(2)));
8293 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
8294 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
8295
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008296 if (const ParamAttrsList *NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008297 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
8298 const Type *NestTy = 0;
8299 uint16_t NestAttr = 0;
8300
8301 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
8302 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
8303 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
8304 if (NestAttrs->paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
8305 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
8306 NestTy = *I;
8307 NestAttr = NestAttrs->getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
8308 break;
8309 }
8310
8311 if (NestTy) {
8312 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
8313 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
8314 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
8315
8316 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
8317 // mean appending it.
8318 {
8319 unsigned Idx = 1;
8320 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
8321 do {
8322 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8323 // Add the chain argument.
8324 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
8325 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
8326 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
8327 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
8328 }
8329
8330 if (I == E)
8331 break;
8332
8333 // Add the original argument.
8334 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
8335
8336 ++Idx, ++I;
8337 } while (1);
8338 }
8339
8340 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
8341 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
8342 // with the chain parameter inserted. Likewise for attributes.
8343
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008344 const ParamAttrsList *Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008345 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
8346 ParamAttrsVector NewAttrs;
8347 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
8348
8349 // Add any function result attributes.
8350 uint16_t Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(0) : 0;
8351 if (Attr)
8352 NewAttrs.push_back (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
8353
8354 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
8355 // mean appending it. Likewise for the chain's attributes.
8356 {
8357 unsigned Idx = 1;
8358 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
8359 E = FTy->param_end();
8360
8361 do {
8362 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
8363 // Add the chain's type and attributes.
8364 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
8365 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
8366 }
8367
8368 if (I == E)
8369 break;
8370
8371 // Add the original type and attributes.
8372 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
8373 Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(Idx) : 0;
8374 if (Attr)
8375 NewAttrs.push_back
8376 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
8377
8378 ++Idx, ++I;
8379 } while (1);
8380 }
8381
8382 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
8383 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8384 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008385 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008386 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
8387 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008388 const ParamAttrsList *NewPAL = ParamAttrsList::get(NewAttrs);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008389
8390 Instruction *NewCaller;
8391 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8392 NewCaller = new InvokeInst(NewCallee,
8393 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8394 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8395 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8396 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008397 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008398 } else {
8399 NewCaller = new CallInst(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
8400 Caller->getName(), Caller);
8401 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8402 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
8403 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
8404 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00008405 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008406 }
8407 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8408 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
8409 Caller->eraseFromParent();
8410 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
8411 return 0;
8412 }
8413 }
8414
8415 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
8416 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
8417 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
8418 Constant *NewCallee =
8419 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
8420 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
8421 return CS.getInstruction();
8422}
8423
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008424/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8425/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8426/// and a single binop.
8427Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8428 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008429 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8430 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008431 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008432 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8433 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8434
8435 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8436 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008437
8438 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8439 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008440 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008441 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008442 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008443 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008444 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8445 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8446 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008447 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008448
8449 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8450 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8451 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8452 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8453 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008454
8455 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8456 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8457 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008458 }
8459
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008460 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8461
8462 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8463 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8464 // hide them behind a phi.
8465 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8466 return 0;
8467
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008468 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008469 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008470 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008471 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8472 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8473 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8474 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008475 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8476 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8477 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008478
8479 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8480 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8481 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8482 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008483 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8484 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8485 }
8486
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008487 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8488 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8489 if (NewLHS) {
8490 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8491 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8492 }
8493 if (NewRHS) {
8494 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8495 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8496 }
8497 }
8498
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008499 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008500 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008501 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8502 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8503 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008504 else {
8505 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8506 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8507 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008508}
8509
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008510/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8511/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8512/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8513/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008514///
8515/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8516/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8517/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008518static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8519 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8520
8521 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8522 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8523 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008524
8525 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8526 // profitable to do this xform.
8527 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8528 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8529 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8530 UI != E; ++UI) {
8531 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8532 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8533 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8534 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8535 }
8536 isAddressTaken = true;
8537 break;
8538 }
8539
8540 if (!isAddressTaken)
8541 return false;
8542 }
8543
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008544 return true;
8545}
8546
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008547
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008548// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8549// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8550// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8551Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8552 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8553
8554 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8555 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8556 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8557 // code size and simplifying code.
8558 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8559 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008560 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008561 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8562 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008563 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008564 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8565 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008566 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008567 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8568 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008569 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8570 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8571 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8572 // load and the PHI.
8573 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8574 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8575 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008576 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008577 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008578 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8579 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8580 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008581 } else {
8582 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8583 }
8584
8585 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8586 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8587 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8588 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008589 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008590 return 0;
8591 if (CastSrcTy) {
8592 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8593 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008594 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008595 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8596 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008597 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8598 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8599 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8600 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008601 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8602 return 0;
8603 }
8604 }
8605
8606 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8607 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8608 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8609 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008610 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008611
8612 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8613 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008614
8615 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008616 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8617 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8618 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8619 InVal = 0;
8620 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8621 }
8622
8623 Value *PhiVal;
8624 if (InVal) {
8625 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8626 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8627 PhiVal = InVal;
8628 delete NewPN;
8629 } else {
8630 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8631 PhiVal = NewPN;
8632 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008633
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008634 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008635 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8636 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008637 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008638 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008639 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008640 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008641 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8642 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8643 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008644 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008645 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008646 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008647}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008648
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008649/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8650/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008651static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8652 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008653 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8654 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8655
8656 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008657 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008658 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00008659
8660 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8661 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
8662 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008663
8664 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8665 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008666
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008667 return false;
8668}
8669
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00008670/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
8671/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
8672/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
8673static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
8674 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
8675 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
8676 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
8677 return true;
8678
8679 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8680 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
8681 return false;
8682
8683 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
8684 // the value.
8685 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8686 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
8687 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
8688 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
8689 return false;
8690 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
8691 return false;
8692 }
8693
8694 return true;
8695}
8696
8697
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008698// PHINode simplification
8699//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008700Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008701 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008702 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008703
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008704 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8706
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008707 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8708 // reducing code size.
8709 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8710 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8711 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8712 return Result;
8713
8714 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8715 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8716 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008717 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8718 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8719 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008720 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008721 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8722 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8724 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008725
8726 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8727 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8728 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8729 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8730 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8731 // late.
8732 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8733 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8734 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8736 }
8737 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008738
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00008739 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
8740 // same value, for example:
8741 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
8742 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
8743 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
8744 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
8745 {
8746 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
8747 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
8748 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
8749 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
8750 ++InValNo;
8751
8752 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
8753 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
8754
8755 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
8756 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
8757 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
8758 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
8759 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
8760 break;
8761 }
8762
8763 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
8764 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
8765 // the value.
8766 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
8767 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
8768 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
8769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
8770 }
8771 }
8772 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008773 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008774}
8775
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008776static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8777 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8778 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008779 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8780 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008781 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8782 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8783 // used for address computation.
8784 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8785 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8786 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8787 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008788}
8789
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008790
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008792 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008793 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008794 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008795 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008796 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008797
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008798 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8800
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008801 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8802 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8803 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8804
8805 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008807
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008808 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8809 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008810
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008811 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008812 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008813 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8814 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008815 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8816 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8817 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8818 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8819 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8820 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8821 MadeChange = true;
8822 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008823 }
8824 }
8825 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008826 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8827 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8828 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8829 // obvious.
8830 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008831 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008832 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008833 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008834 MadeChange = true;
8835 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008836 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8837 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008838 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8839 MadeChange = true;
8840 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008841 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008842 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008843 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8844
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008845 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8846 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8847 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008848 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8849 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
8850 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
8851 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
8852 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
8853 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00008854 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
8855 if (I != BCI) {
8856 I->takeName(BCI);
8857 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
8858 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
8859 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008860 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00008861 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00008862 }
8863 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
8864 }
8865 }
8866
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008867 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8868 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8869 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8870 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008871 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008872 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008873 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008874
8875 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008876 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8877 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8878 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8879 //
8880 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8881 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8882 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8883
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008884 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008885
8886 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8887 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8888 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8889 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008890 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008891
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008892 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008893 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008894 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8895 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8896 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008897 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008898 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8899 Sum = GO1;
8900 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8901 Sum = SO1;
8902 } else {
8903 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8904 // target's pointer size.
8905 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8906 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008907 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008908 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008909 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008910 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008911 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
8912 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008913 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008914 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008915
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00008916 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008917 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008918 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008919 } else {
8920 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008921 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8922 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008923 }
8924 }
8925 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008926 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8927 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8928 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008929 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8930 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008931 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008932 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008933
8934 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8935 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8936 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8937 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8938 return &GEP;
8939 } else {
8940 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8941 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8942 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8943 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8944 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008945 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008946 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008947 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008948 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008949 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8950 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008951 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8952 }
8953
8954 if (!Indices.empty())
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008955 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
8956 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008957
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008958 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008959 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8960 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8961
8962 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008963 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008964 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8965 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8966 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8967
8968 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008969 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8970 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008971
8972 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8973 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8974 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008975 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008976 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8977 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8978 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00008979 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
8980 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008981 //
8982 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8983 //
8984 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8985 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8986 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8987 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8988 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8989 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8990 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8991 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8992 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8993 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8994 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8995 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8996 return &GEP;
8997 }
8998 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8999 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009000 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9001 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009002 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9003 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9004 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009005 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9006 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009007 Value *Idx[2];
9008 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9009 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009010 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009011 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009012 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9013 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009014 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009015
9016 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009017 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009018 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009019 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009020
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009021 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009022 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009023 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009024
9025 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9026 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9027 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9028 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9029 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9030 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9031 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9032 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009033 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009034 Scale = CI;
9035 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9036 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9037 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009038 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9039 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9040 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009041 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9042 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9043 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
9044 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9045 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9046 }
9047 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009048
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009049 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009050 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
9051 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
9052 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
9053 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
9054 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
9055 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
9056 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009057 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009058 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009059 false /*ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009060 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
9061 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
9062 }
9063
9064 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009065 Value *Idx[2];
9066 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9067 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009068 Instruction *NewGEP =
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009069 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009070 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
9071 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
9072 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009073 }
9074 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009075 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009076 }
9077
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009078 return 0;
9079}
9080
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009081Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
9082 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
9083 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009084 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9085 const Type *NewTy =
9086 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009087 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009088
9089 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
9090 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009091 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009092 else {
9093 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009094 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009095 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009096
9097 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009098
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009099 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
9100 // allocas if possible...
9101 //
9102 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
9103 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
9104
9105 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
9106 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
9107 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009108 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009109 Value *Idx[2];
9110 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
9111 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
9112 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00009113 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009114
9115 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
9116 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009118 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9119 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009120 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009121
9122 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
9123 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
9124 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009125 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009126 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009127 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
9128
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009129 return 0;
9130}
9131
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009132Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
9133 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
9134
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009135 // free undef -> unreachable.
9136 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
9137 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009138 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009139 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009140 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9141 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009142
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009143 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
9144 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009145 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009146 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00009147
9148 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
9149 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
9150 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
9151 return &FI;
9152 }
9153
9154 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
9155 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
9156 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9157 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
9158 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
9159 return &FI;
9160 }
9161 }
9162
9163 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
9164 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
9165 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
9166 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
9167 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
9168 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00009169
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00009170 return 0;
9171}
9172
9173
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009174/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009175static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
9176 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009177 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009178 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009179
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009180 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
9181 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
9182 // directly if string length is small enough.
9183 const std::string &Str = CE->getOperand(0)->getStringValue();
9184 if (!Str.empty()) {
9185 unsigned len = Str.length();
9186 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
9187 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9188 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
9189 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
9190 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
9191 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
9192 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
9193 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
9194 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9195 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9196 }
9197 } else {
9198 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
9199 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
9200 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9201 }
9202 // Append NULL at the end.
9203 SingleChar = 0;
9204 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
9205 }
9206 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
9207 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
9208 }
9209 }
9210 }
9211
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009212 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009213 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009214 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009215
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009216 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009217 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009218 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9219 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9220 // constants.
9221 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9222 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9223 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009224 Value *Idxs[2];
9225 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9226 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009227 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9228 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9229 }
9230
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009231 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009232 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00009233 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
9234 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
9235 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009236 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9237 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009238
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009239 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
9240 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
9241 // the result of the loaded value.
9242 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
9243 CI->getName(),
9244 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
9245 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009246 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00009247 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00009248 }
9249 }
9250 return 0;
9251}
9252
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009253/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009254/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
9255/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
9256/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
9257static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009258 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
9259 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
9260
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00009261 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009262 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +00009263 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +00009264 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009265
9266 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
9267 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009268 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
9269 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
9270 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009271 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
9272
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009273 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009274 --BBI;
9275
9276 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
9277 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
9278 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
9279 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009280
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00009281 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009282 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009283}
9284
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009285/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
9286/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
9287/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
9288/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
9289static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
9290 while (1) {
9291 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
9292 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
9293 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
9294 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
9295 else
9296 return Ptr;
9297 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
9298 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
9299 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
9300 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
9301 } else {
9302 return Ptr;
9303 }
9304 }
9305}
9306
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009307Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
9308 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00009309
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009310 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009311 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009312 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
9313 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9314
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009315 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009316 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009317 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009318 return Res;
9319
9320 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
9321 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009322
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009323 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
9324 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009325 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
9326 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009327 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
9328 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
9329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00009330 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
9331 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
9332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00009333 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009334
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +00009335 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
9336 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
9337 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
9338 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
9339 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009340 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9341 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9342 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9343 // CFG.
9344 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9345 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9347 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +00009348 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009349
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009350 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009351 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +00009352 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
9353 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
9354 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009355 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
9356 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
9357 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009358 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9359 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009361 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009362
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009363 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
9364 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009365 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009366 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009367
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009368 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
9369 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
9370 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
9371 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009372 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00009373 if (Constant *V =
9374 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009376 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
9377 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9378 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9379 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9380 // CFG.
9381 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9382 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9384 }
9385
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009386 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +00009387 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009388 return Res;
9389 }
9390 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009391
9392 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
9393 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
9394 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
9395 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
9396 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
9397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
9398 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
9399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9400 }
9401 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00009402
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009403 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009404 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
9405 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
9406 // exposes redundancy in the code.
9407 //
9408 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
9409 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
9410 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
9411 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
9412 // unconditionally.
9413 //
9414 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
9415 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009416 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
9417 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009418 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009419 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009420 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009421 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009422 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
9423 }
9424
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00009425 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
9426 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
9427 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9428 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
9429 return &LI;
9430 }
9431
9432 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
9433 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
9434 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9435 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
9436 return &LI;
9437 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009438 }
9439 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009440 return 0;
9441}
9442
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00009443/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009444/// when possible.
9445static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
9446 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
9447 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
9448
9449 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9450 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
9451 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9452
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009453 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009454 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9455 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9456 // constants.
9457 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9458 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9459 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009460 Value* Idxs[2];
9461 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9462 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009463 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9464 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9465 }
9466
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009467 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
9468 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9469 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009470
9471 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009472 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
9473 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009474 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009475 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009476 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
9477 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
9478 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
9479 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
9480 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009481 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009482 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00009483 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009484 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
9485 }
9486 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009487 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009488 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009489 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009490 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
9491 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009492 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
9493 }
9494 }
9495 }
9496 return 0;
9497}
9498
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009499Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
9500 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
9501 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
9502
9503 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009504 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009505 ++NumCombined;
9506 return 0;
9507 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00009508
9509 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
9510 // alloca dead.
9511 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
9512 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
9513 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9514 ++NumCombined;
9515 return 0;
9516 }
9517
9518 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
9519 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
9520 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
9521 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9522 ++NumCombined;
9523 return 0;
9524 }
9525 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009526
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009527 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009528 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009529 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
9530 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9531
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009532 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
9533 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
9534 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
9535 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
9536 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
9537 --ScanInsts) {
9538 --BBI;
9539
9540 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
9541 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
9542 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
9543 ++NumDeadStore;
9544 ++BBI;
9545 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
9546 continue;
9547 }
9548 break;
9549 }
9550
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009551 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
9552 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
9553 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
9554 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +00009555 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009556 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9557 ++NumCombined;
9558 return 0;
9559 }
9560 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9561 // may not be dead.
9562 break;
9563 }
9564
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009565 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009566 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009567 break;
9568 }
9569
9570
9571 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009572
9573 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9574 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9575 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9576 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9577 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009578 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009579 ++NumCombined;
9580 }
9581 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9582 }
9583
9584 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9585 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009586 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009587 ++NumCombined;
9588 return 0;
9589 }
9590
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009591 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9592 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009593 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009594 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9595 return Res;
9596 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009597 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009598 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9599 return Res;
9600
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009601
9602 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9603 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009604 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009605 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009606 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9607 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9608 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009609
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009610 return 0;
9611}
9612
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009613/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9614/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9615/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9616///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009617/// Simplify things like:
9618/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9619/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9620///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009621bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9622 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9623
9624 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9625 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9626 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009627 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009628
9629 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9630 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009631 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9632 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009633 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009634 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009635 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009636 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009637 return false;
9638
9639 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009640 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009641 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009642 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009643 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009644 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009645 return false;
9646
9647
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009648 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9649 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009650 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009651 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009652 return false;
9653
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009654 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9655 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9656 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9657 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9658 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9659 --BBI;
9660 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9661 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9662 return false;
9663 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009664 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009665 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9666 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9667 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9668 return false;
9669
9670 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009671 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9672 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009673 for (;; --BBI) {
9674 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9675 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9676 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9677 return false;
9678 break;
9679 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009680 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9681 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009682 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9683 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9684 return false;
9685 }
9686
9687 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9688 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9689 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9690 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9691 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9692 return false;
9693 }
9694 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009695
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009696 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009697 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9698 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9699 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9700 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9701 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009702 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9703 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009704 }
9705
9706 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9707 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009708 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009709 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9710 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9711 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9712
9713 // Nuke the old stores.
9714 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9715 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9716 ++NumCombined;
9717 return true;
9718}
9719
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009720
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009721Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9722 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009723 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009724 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9725 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9726 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9727 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9728 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9729 BI.setCondition(X);
9730 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9731 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9732 return &BI;
9733 }
9734
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009735 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9736 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9737 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9738 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9739 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9740 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9741 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009742 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009743 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9744 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009745 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9746 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9747 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9748 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009749 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009750 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009751 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009752 return &BI;
9753 }
9754
9755 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9756 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9757 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9758 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9759 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9760 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9761 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9762 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009763 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009764 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9765 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009766 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009767 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009768 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9769 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009770 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009771 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009772 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009773 return &BI;
9774 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009775
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009776 return 0;
9777}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009778
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009779Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9780 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9781 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9782 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9783 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9784 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9785 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009786 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009787 AddRHS));
9788 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009789 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009790 return &SI;
9791 }
9792 }
9793 return 0;
9794}
9795
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009796/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9797/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9798static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9799 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9800 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009801 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009802 if (isConstant) return true;
9803 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9804 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9805 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9806 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9807 return false;
9808 return true;
9809 }
9810 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9811 if (!I) return false;
9812
9813 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9814 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9815 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9816 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9817 return true;
9818 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9819 return true;
9820 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9821 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9822 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9823 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9824 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009825 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9826 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9827 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9828 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9829 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009830
9831 return false;
9832}
9833
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009834/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9835///
9836/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9837/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009838static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9839 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9840 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9841 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9842 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9843 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9844
9845 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009846 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009847 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9848 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9849 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9850 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009851 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009852 return Result;
9853}
9854
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009855/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9856/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9857/// extracted from the vector.
9858static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009859 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9860 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009861 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9862 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009863 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9864
9865 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9866 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9867 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9868 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009869 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009870 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9871 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9872 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009873 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9874 return 0;
9875 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009876
9877 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9878 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009879 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9880 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009881
9882 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9883 // vector input.
9884 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009885 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009886 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9887 if (InEl < Width)
9888 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9889 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9890 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9891 else
9892 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009893 }
9894
9895 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9896 return 0;
9897}
9898
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009899Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009900
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009901 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009902 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9903 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9904
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009905 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009906 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9907 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9908
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009909 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009910 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009911 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009912 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009913 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009914 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9915 op0 = 0;
9916 break;
9917 }
9918 if (op0)
9919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009920 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009921
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009922 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9923 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009924 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009925 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9926 unsigned VectorWidth =
9927 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9928
9929 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9930 // crashing the code below.
9931 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9933
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009934 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9935 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9936 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009937 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009938 uint64_t UndefElts;
9939 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009940 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009941 UndefElts)) {
9942 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9943 return &EI;
9944 }
9945 }
9946
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009947 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009949
9950 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9951 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9952 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9953 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9954 if (const VectorType *VT =
9955 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9956 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9957 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9958 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9959 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009960 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009961
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009962 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009963 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9964 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9965 // profitable to do so
9966 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009967 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9968 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9969 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9970 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9971 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9972 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9973 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9974 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9975 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9976 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9977 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9978 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009979 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009980 unsigned AS =
9981 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009982 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009983 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS), EI);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009984 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009985 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009986 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9987 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009988 }
9989 }
9990 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9991 // Extracting the inserted element?
9992 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9994 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9995 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9996 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9997 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9998 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9999 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
10000 return &EI;
10001 }
10002 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
10003 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
10004 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010005 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10006 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010007 Value *Src;
10008 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
10009 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
10010 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
10011 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10012 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
10013 } else {
10014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000010015 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010016 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010017 }
10018 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010019 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010020 return 0;
10021}
10022
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010023/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
10024/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
10025/// Otherwise, return false.
10026static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
10027 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
10028 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
10029 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010030 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010031
10032 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010033 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010034 return true;
10035 } else if (V == LHS) {
10036 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010037 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010038 return true;
10039 } else if (V == RHS) {
10040 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010041 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010042 return true;
10043 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10044 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10045 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10046 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10047 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10048
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010049 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
10050 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010051 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010052
10053 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
10054 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10055 // transitively ok.
10056 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10057 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010058 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000010059 return true;
10060 }
10061 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
10062 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010063 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10064 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010065 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010066
10067 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
10068 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
10069 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
10070 // transitively ok.
10071 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
10072 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
10073 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
10074 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010075 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010076 } else {
10077 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
10078 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010079 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010080
10081 }
10082 return true;
10083 }
10084 }
10085 }
10086 }
10087 }
10088 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
10089
10090 return false;
10091}
10092
10093/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
10094/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
10095/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010096static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010097 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010098 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010099 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010100 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010101 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010102
10103 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010104 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010105 return V;
10106 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010107 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010108 return V;
10109 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10110 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
10111 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
10112 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
10113 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
10114
10115 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10116 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10117 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
10118 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010119 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
10120 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010121
10122 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
10123 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010124 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
10125 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
10126 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010127 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010128 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010129 return V;
10130 }
10131
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010132 if (VecOp == RHS) {
10133 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010134 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
10135 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
10136 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010137 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010138 }
10139 return V;
10140 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010141
10142 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
10143 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
10144 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
10145 return EI->getOperand(0);
10146
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010147 }
10148 }
10149 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010150 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010151
10152 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
10153 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010154 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010155 return V;
10156}
10157
10158Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
10159 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
10160 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
10161 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
10162
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000010163 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
10164 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
10165 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10166
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010167 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
10168 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
10169 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
10170 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
10171 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
10172 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000010173 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
10174 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010175 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010176
10177 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
10178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10179
10180 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
10181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
10182
10183 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
10184 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
10185 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
10186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
10187
10188 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
10189 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
10190 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
10191 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
10192 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
10193 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
10194 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
10195 // Build a new shuffle mask.
10196 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
10197 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010198 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010199 else {
10200 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010201 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010202 NumVectorElts));
10203 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010204 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010205 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010206 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010207 }
10208
10209 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
10210 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
10211 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
10212 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000010213 Value *RHS = 0;
10214 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
10215 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
10216 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010217 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010218 }
10219 }
10220 }
10221
10222 return 0;
10223}
10224
10225
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010226Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
10227 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
10228 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010229 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010230
10231 bool MadeChange = false;
10232
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010233 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010234 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
10236
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010237 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010238 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010239 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
10240 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
10241 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
10242 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10243 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
10244 Mask[i] = 2*e;
10245 MadeChange = true;
10246 }
10247 }
10248
10249 if (MadeChange) {
10250 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
10251 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10252 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10253 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
10254 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
10255 else
10256 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
10257 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010258 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000010259 }
10260 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000010261
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010262 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
10263 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
10264 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
10265 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010266 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
10267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
10268 }
10269
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010270 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
10271 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10272 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010273 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010274 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010275 else {
10276 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
10277 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
10278 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
10279 else
10280 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010281 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010282 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010283 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010284 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010285 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010286 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010287 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
10288 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010289 MadeChange = true;
10290 }
10291
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010292 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010293 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000010294
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010295 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10296 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
10297 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
10298 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
10299
10300 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
10301 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000010302 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010303
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010304 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
10305 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
10306 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010307
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010308 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
10309 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
10310 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
10311 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
10312 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
10313 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
10314 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
10315 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
10316 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
10317 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
10318 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
10319 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
10320
10321 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
10322 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
10323 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
10324 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
10325 else
10326 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
10327
10328 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
10329 // the replacement.
10330 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
10331 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
10332 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10333 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010334 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010335 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010336 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010337 }
10338 }
10339 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
10340 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010341 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000010342 }
10343 }
10344 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000010345
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000010346 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
10347}
10348
10349
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010350
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010351
10352/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
10353/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
10354/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
10355/// end of its block.
10356static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
10357 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
10358
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000010359 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
10360 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010361
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010362 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000010363 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
10364 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010365 return false;
10366
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010367 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
10368 // the end of block that could change the value.
10369 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010370 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
10371 Scan != E; ++Scan)
10372 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
10373 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010374 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010375
10376 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
10377 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
10378
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000010379 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010380 ++NumSunkInst;
10381 return true;
10382}
10383
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010384
10385/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
10386/// all reachable code to the worklist.
10387///
10388/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
10389/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
10390/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
10391/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
10392/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
10393///
10394static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010395 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010396 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010397 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010398 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
10399 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010400
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010401 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10402 BB = Worklist.back();
10403 Worklist.pop_back();
10404
10405 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
10406 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
10407
10408 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
10409 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010410
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010411 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
10412 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
10413 ++NumDeadInst;
10414 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
10415 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10416 continue;
10417 }
10418
10419 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
10420 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
10421 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
10422 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
10423 ++NumConstProp;
10424 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10425 continue;
10426 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000010427
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010428 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010429 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010430
10431 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
10432 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
10433 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
10434 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
10435 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
10436 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
10437 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
10438 continue;
10439 }
10440 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
10441 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
10442 // See if this is an explicit destination.
10443 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10444 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
10445 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
10446 continue;
10447 }
10448
10449 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
10450 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
10451 continue;
10452 }
10453 }
10454
10455 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10456 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010457 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010458}
10459
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010460bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010461 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000010462 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010463
10464 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
10465 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010466
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010467 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010468 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
10469 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
10470 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010471 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010472 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000010473
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010474 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
10475 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
10476 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
10477 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
10478 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
10479 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
10480 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
10481 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000010482
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010483 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010484 ++NumDeadInst;
10485
10486 if (!I->use_empty())
10487 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
10488 I->eraseFromParent();
10489 }
10490 }
10491 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010492
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010493 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10494 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
10495 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010496
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010497 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010498 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010499 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010500 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010501 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010502 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010503
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010504 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010505
10506 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010507 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010508 continue;
10509 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010510
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010511 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000010512 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010513 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010514
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010515 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010516 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000010517 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
10518
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010519 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010520 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010521 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010522 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010523 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010524
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010525 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
10526 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10527 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
10528 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
10529 if (UserParent != BB) {
10530 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
10531 // See if the user is one of our successors.
10532 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
10533 if (*SI == UserParent) {
10534 UserIsSuccessor = true;
10535 break;
10536 }
10537
10538 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
10539 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
10540 // otherwise), we can keep going.
10541 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
10542 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
10543 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
10544 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
10545 }
10546 }
10547
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010548 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010549#ifndef NDEBUG
10550 std::string OrigI;
10551#endif
10552 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010553 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000010554 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010555 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010556 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010557 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
10558 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010559
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010560 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
10561 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
10562
10563 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010564 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010565 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010566
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010567 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10568 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010569
10570 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10571 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010572 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10573
10574 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10575 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10576 ++InsertPos;
10577
10578 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010579
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010580 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10581 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010582 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010583
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010584 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10585 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010586 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010587
10588 // Erase the old instruction.
10589 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010590 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010591#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010592 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10593 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010594#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010595
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010596 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10597 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010598 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10599 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10600 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010601 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010602
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010603 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010604 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010605 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010606 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010607 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010608 AddToWorkList(I);
10609 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010610 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010611 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010612 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010613 }
10614 }
10615
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010616 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000010617
10618 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
10619 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010620 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010621}
10622
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010623
10624bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010625 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10626
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010627 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10628
10629 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10630 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10631 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10632 EverMadeChange = true;
10633 return EverMadeChange;
10634}
10635
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010636FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010637 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010638}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010639